Home | History | Annotate | Download | only in info
      1 This is ld.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.8 from ld.texinfo.
      2 
      3 INFO-DIR-SECTION Software development
      4 START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
      5 * Ld: (ld).                       The GNU linker.
      6 END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
      7 
      8    This file documents the GNU linker LD (GNU Binutils) version 2.25.
      9 
     10    Copyright (C) 1991-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
     11 
     12    Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
     13 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
     14 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
     15 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
     16 Texts.  A copy of the license is included in the section entitled "GNU
     17 Free Documentation License".
     18 
     19 
     20 File: ld.info,  Node: Top,  Next: Overview,  Up: (dir)
     21 
     22 LD
     23 **
     24 
     25 This file documents the GNU linker ld (GNU Binutils) version 2.25.
     26 
     27    This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
     28 Documentation License version 1.3.  A copy of the license is included
     29 in the section entitled "GNU Free Documentation License".
     30 
     31 * Menu:
     32 
     33 * Overview::                    Overview
     34 * Invocation::                  Invocation
     35 * Scripts::                     Linker Scripts
     36 
     37 * Machine Dependent::           Machine Dependent Features
     38 
     39 * BFD::                         BFD
     40 
     41 * Reporting Bugs::              Reporting Bugs
     42 * MRI::                         MRI Compatible Script Files
     43 * GNU Free Documentation License::  GNU Free Documentation License
     44 * LD Index::                       LD Index
     45 
     46 
     47 File: ld.info,  Node: Overview,  Next: Invocation,  Prev: Top,  Up: Top
     48 
     49 1 Overview
     50 **********
     51 
     52 `ld' combines a number of object and archive files, relocates their
     53 data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in compiling
     54 a program is to run `ld'.
     55 
     56    `ld' accepts Linker Command Language files written in a superset of
     57 AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax, to provide explicit and
     58 total control over the linking process.
     59 
     60    This version of `ld' uses the general purpose BFD libraries to
     61 operate on object files. This allows `ld' to read, combine, and write
     62 object files in many different formats--for example, COFF or `a.out'.
     63 Different formats may be linked together to produce any available kind
     64 of object file.  *Note BFD::, for more information.
     65 
     66    Aside from its flexibility, the GNU linker is more helpful than other
     67 linkers in providing diagnostic information.  Many linkers abandon
     68 execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
     69 `ld' continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors (or, in
     70 some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
     71 
     72 
     73 File: ld.info,  Node: Invocation,  Next: Scripts,  Prev: Overview,  Up: Top
     74 
     75 2 Invocation
     76 ************
     77 
     78 The GNU linker `ld' is meant to cover a broad range of situations, and
     79 to be as compatible as possible with other linkers.  As a result, you
     80 have many choices to control its behavior.
     81 
     82 * Menu:
     83 
     84 * Options::                     Command Line Options
     85 * Environment::                 Environment Variables
     86 
     87 
     88 File: ld.info,  Node: Options,  Next: Environment,  Up: Invocation
     89 
     90 2.1 Command Line Options
     91 ========================
     92 
     93    The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
     94 practice few of them are used in any particular context.  For instance,
     95 a frequent use of `ld' is to link standard Unix object files on a
     96 standard, supported Unix system.  On such a system, to link a file
     97 `hello.o':
     98 
     99      ld -o OUTPUT /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
    100 
    101    This tells `ld' to produce a file called OUTPUT as the result of
    102 linking the file `/lib/crt0.o' with `hello.o' and the library `libc.a',
    103 which will come from the standard search directories.  (See the
    104 discussion of the `-l' option below.)
    105 
    106    Some of the command-line options to `ld' may be specified at any
    107 point in the command line.  However, options which refer to files, such
    108 as `-l' or `-T', cause the file to be read at the point at which the
    109 option appears in the command line, relative to the object files and
    110 other file options.  Repeating non-file options with a different
    111 argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
    112 occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
    113 option.  Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
    114 noted in the descriptions below.
    115 
    116    Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be
    117 linked together.  They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with
    118 command-line options, except that an object file argument may not be
    119 placed between an option and its argument.
    120 
    121    Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you
    122 can specify other forms of binary input files using `-l', `-R', and the
    123 script command language.  If _no_ binary input files at all are
    124 specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
    125 message `No input files'.
    126 
    127    If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
    128 assume that it is a linker script.  A script specified in this way
    129 augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
    130 linker script or the one specified by using `-T').  This feature
    131 permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
    132 or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
    133 `INPUT' or `GROUP' to load other objects.  Specifying a script in this
    134 way merely augments the main linker script, with the extra commands
    135 placed after the main script; use the `-T' option to replace the
    136 default linker script entirely, but note the effect of the `INSERT'
    137 command.  *Note Scripts::.
    138 
    139    For options whose names are a single letter, option arguments must
    140 either follow the option letter without intervening whitespace, or be
    141 given as separate arguments immediately following the option that
    142 requires them.
    143 
    144    For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two
    145 can precede the option name; for example, `-trace-symbol' and
    146 `--trace-symbol' are equivalent.  Note--there is one exception to this
    147 rule.  Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
    148 only be preceded by two dashes.  This is to reduce confusion with the
    149 `-o' option.  So for example `-omagic' sets the output file name to
    150 `magic' whereas `--omagic' sets the NMAGIC flag on the output.
    151 
    152    Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from
    153 the option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
    154 immediately following the option that requires them.  For example,
    155 `--trace-symbol foo' and `--trace-symbol=foo' are equivalent.  Unique
    156 abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are accepted.
    157 
    158    Note--if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler
    159 driver (e.g. `gcc') then all the linker command line options should be
    160 prefixed by `-Wl,' (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
    161 compiler driver) like this:
    162 
    163        gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
    164 
    165    This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
    166 silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link.  Confusion
    167 may also arise when passing options that require values through a
    168 driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as a
    169 separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
    170 and the argument to the compiler.  In this case, it is simplest to use
    171 the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
    172 
    173        gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
    174 
    175    Here is a table of the generic command line switches accepted by the
    176 GNU linker:
    177 
    178 `@FILE'
    179      Read command-line options from FILE.  The options read are
    180      inserted in place of the original @FILE option.  If FILE does not
    181      exist, or cannot be read, then the option will be treated
    182      literally, and not removed.
    183 
    184      Options in FILE are separated by whitespace.  A whitespace
    185      character may be included in an option by surrounding the entire
    186      option in either single or double quotes.  Any character
    187      (including a backslash) may be included by prefixing the character
    188      to be included with a backslash.  The FILE may itself contain
    189      additional @FILE options; any such options will be processed
    190      recursively.
    191 
    192 `-a KEYWORD'
    193      This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility.  The KEYWORD
    194      argument must be one of the strings `archive', `shared', or
    195      `default'.  `-aarchive' is functionally equivalent to `-Bstatic',
    196      and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent to
    197      `-Bdynamic'.  This option may be used any number of times.
    198 
    199 `--audit AUDITLIB'
    200      Adds AUDITLIB to the `DT_AUDIT' entry of the dynamic section.
    201      AUDITLIB is not checked for existence, nor will it use the
    202      DT_SONAME specified in the library.  If specified multiple times
    203      `DT_AUDIT' will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces
    204      to use. If the linker finds an object with an audit entry while
    205      searching for shared libraries, it will add a corresponding
    206      `DT_DEPAUDIT' entry in the output file.  This option is only
    207      meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
    208 
    209 `-A ARCHITECTURE'
    210 `--architecture=ARCHITECTURE'
    211      In the current release of `ld', this option is useful only for the
    212      Intel 960 family of architectures.  In that `ld' configuration, the
    213      ARCHITECTURE argument identifies the particular architecture in
    214      the 960 family, enabling some safeguards and modifying the
    215      archive-library search path.  *Note `ld' and the Intel 960 family:
    216      i960, for details.
    217 
    218      Future releases of `ld' may support similar functionality for
    219      other architecture families.
    220 
    221 `-b INPUT-FORMAT'
    222 `--format=INPUT-FORMAT'
    223      `ld' may be configured to support more than one kind of object
    224      file.  If your `ld' is configured this way, you can use the `-b'
    225      option to specify the binary format for input object files that
    226      follow this option on the command line.  Even when `ld' is
    227      configured to support alternative object formats, you don't
    228      usually need to specify this, as `ld' should be configured to
    229      expect as a default input format the most usual format on each
    230      machine.  INPUT-FORMAT is a text string, the name of a particular
    231      format supported by the BFD libraries.  (You can list the
    232      available binary formats with `objdump -i'.)  *Note BFD::.
    233 
    234      You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an
    235      unusual binary format.  You can also use `-b' to switch formats
    236      explicitly (when linking object files of different formats), by
    237      including `-b INPUT-FORMAT' before each group of object files in a
    238      particular format.
    239 
    240      The default format is taken from the environment variable
    241      `GNUTARGET'.  *Note Environment::.  You can also define the input
    242      format from a script, using the command `TARGET'; see *Note Format
    243      Commands::.
    244 
    245 `-c MRI-COMMANDFILE'
    246 `--mri-script=MRI-COMMANDFILE'
    247      For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, `ld' accepts script
    248      files written in an alternate, restricted command language,
    249      described in *Note MRI Compatible Script Files: MRI.  Introduce
    250      MRI script files with the option `-c'; use the `-T' option to run
    251      linker scripts written in the general-purpose `ld' scripting
    252      language.  If MRI-CMDFILE does not exist, `ld' looks for it in the
    253      directories specified by any `-L' options.
    254 
    255 `-d'
    256 `-dc'
    257 `-dp'
    258      These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported
    259      for compatibility with other linkers.  They assign space to common
    260      symbols even if a relocatable output file is specified (with
    261      `-r').  The script command `FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION' has the same
    262      effect.  *Note Miscellaneous Commands::.
    263 
    264 `--depaudit AUDITLIB'
    265 `-P AUDITLIB'
    266      Adds AUDITLIB to the `DT_DEPAUDIT' entry of the dynamic section.
    267      AUDITLIB is not checked for existence, nor will it use the
    268      DT_SONAME specified in the library.  If specified multiple times
    269      `DT_DEPAUDIT' will contain a colon separated list of audit
    270      interfaces to use.  This option is only meaningful on ELF
    271      platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.  The -P option is
    272      provided for Solaris compatibility.
    273 
    274 `-e ENTRY'
    275 `--entry=ENTRY'
    276      Use ENTRY as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
    277      program, rather than the default entry point.  If there is no
    278      symbol named ENTRY, the linker will try to parse ENTRY as a number,
    279      and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted
    280      in base 10; you may use a leading `0x' for base 16, or a leading
    281      `0' for base 8).  *Note Entry Point::, for a discussion of defaults
    282      and other ways of specifying the entry point.
    283 
    284 `--exclude-libs LIB,LIB,...'
    285      Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should
    286      not be automatically exported.  The library names may be delimited
    287      by commas or colons.  Specifying `--exclude-libs ALL' excludes
    288      symbols in all archive libraries from automatic export.  This
    289      option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port of the
    290      linker and for ELF targeted ports.  For i386 PE, symbols
    291      explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of
    292      this option.  For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this
    293      option will be treated as hidden.
    294 
    295 `--exclude-modules-for-implib MODULE,MODULE,...'
    296      Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which
    297      symbols should not be automatically exported, but which should be
    298      copied wholesale into the import library being generated during
    299      the link.  The module names may be delimited by commas or colons,
    300      and must match exactly the filenames used by `ld' to open the
    301      files; for archive members, this is simply the member name, but
    302      for object files the name listed must include and match precisely
    303      any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
    304      command-line.  This option is available only for the i386 PE
    305      targeted port of the linker.  Symbols explicitly listed in a .def
    306      file are still exported, regardless of this option.
    307 
    308 `-E'
    309 `--export-dynamic'
    310 `--no-export-dynamic'
    311      When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the `-E'
    312      option or the `--export-dynamic' option causes the linker to add
    313      all symbols to the dynamic symbol table.  The dynamic symbol table
    314      is the set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at
    315      run time.
    316 
    317      If you do not use either of these options (or use the
    318      `--no-export-dynamic' option to restore the default behavior), the
    319      dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols
    320      which are referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
    321 
    322      If you use `dlopen' to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
    323      back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
    324      dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
    325      linking the program itself.
    326 
    327      You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
    328      be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports
    329      it.  See the description of `--dynamic-list'.
    330 
    331      Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports.  PE
    332      targets support a similar function to export all symbols from a
    333      DLL or EXE; see the description of `--export-all-symbols' below.
    334 
    335 `-EB'
    336      Link big-endian objects.  This affects the default output format.
    337 
    338 `-EL'
    339      Link little-endian objects.  This affects the default output
    340      format.
    341 
    342 `-f NAME'
    343 `--auxiliary=NAME'
    344      When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY
    345      field to the specified name.  This tells the dynamic linker that
    346      the symbol table of the shared object should be used as an
    347      auxiliary filter on the symbol table of the shared object NAME.
    348 
    349      If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when
    350      you run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY
    351      field.  If the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter
    352      object, it will first check whether there is a definition in the
    353      shared object NAME.  If there is one, it will be used instead of
    354      the definition in the filter object.  The shared object NAME need
    355      not exist.  Thus the shared object NAME may be used to provide an
    356      alternative implementation of certain functions, perhaps for
    357      debugging or for machine specific performance.
    358 
    359      This option may be specified more than once.  The DT_AUXILIARY
    360      entries will be created in the order in which they appear on the
    361      command line.
    362 
    363 `-F NAME'
    364 `--filter=NAME'
    365      When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER
    366      field to the specified name.  This tells the dynamic linker that
    367      the symbol table of the shared object which is being created
    368      should be used as a filter on the symbol table of the shared
    369      object NAME.
    370 
    371      If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when
    372      you run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER
    373      field.  The dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the
    374      symbol table of the filter object as usual, but it will actually
    375      link to the definitions found in the shared object NAME.  Thus the
    376      filter object can be used to select a subset of the symbols
    377      provided by the object NAME.
    378 
    379      Some older linkers used the `-F' option throughout a compilation
    380      toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and
    381      output object files.  The GNU linker uses other mechanisms for
    382      this purpose: the `-b', `--format', `--oformat' options, the
    383      `TARGET' command in linker scripts, and the `GNUTARGET'
    384      environment variable.  The GNU linker will ignore the `-F' option
    385      when not creating an ELF shared object.
    386 
    387 `-fini=NAME'
    388      When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when
    389      the executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to
    390      the address of the function.  By default, the linker uses `_fini'
    391      as the function to call.
    392 
    393 `-g'
    394      Ignored.  Provided for compatibility with other tools.
    395 
    396 `-G VALUE'
    397 `--gpsize=VALUE'
    398      Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP
    399      register to SIZE.  This is only meaningful for object file formats
    400      such as MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into
    401      different sections.  This is ignored for other object file formats.
    402 
    403 `-h NAME'
    404 `-soname=NAME'
    405      When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME
    406      field to the specified name.  When an executable is linked with a
    407      shared object which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the
    408      executable is run the dynamic linker will attempt to load the
    409      shared object specified by the DT_SONAME field rather than the
    410      using the file name given to the linker.
    411 
    412 `-i'
    413      Perform an incremental link (same as option `-r').
    414 
    415 `-init=NAME'
    416      When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when
    417      the executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to
    418      the address of the function.  By default, the linker uses `_init'
    419      as the function to call.
    420 
    421 `-l NAMESPEC'
    422 `--library=NAMESPEC'
    423      Add the archive or object file specified by NAMESPEC to the list
    424      of files to link.  This option may be used any number of times.
    425      If NAMESPEC is of the form `:FILENAME', `ld' will search the
    426      library path for a file called FILENAME, otherwise it will search
    427      the library path for a file called `libNAMESPEC.a'.
    428 
    429      On systems which support shared libraries, `ld' may also search for
    430      files other than `libNAMESPEC.a'.  Specifically, on ELF and SunOS
    431      systems, `ld' will search a directory for a library called
    432      `libNAMESPEC.so' before searching for one called `libNAMESPEC.a'.
    433      (By convention, a `.so' extension indicates a shared library.)
    434      Note that this behavior does not apply to `:FILENAME', which
    435      always specifies a file called FILENAME.
    436 
    437      The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where
    438      it is specified on the command line.  If the archive defines a
    439      symbol which was undefined in some object which appeared before
    440      the archive on the command line, the linker will include the
    441      appropriate file(s) from the archive.  However, an undefined
    442      symbol in an object appearing later on the command line will not
    443      cause the linker to search the archive again.
    444 
    445      See the `-(' option for a way to force the linker to search
    446      archives multiple times.
    447 
    448      You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
    449 
    450      This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers.
    451      However, if you are using `ld' on AIX, note that it is different
    452      from the behaviour of the AIX linker.
    453 
    454 `-L SEARCHDIR'
    455 `--library-path=SEARCHDIR'
    456      Add path SEARCHDIR to the list of paths that `ld' will search for
    457      archive libraries and `ld' control scripts.  You may use this
    458      option any number of times.  The directories are searched in the
    459      order in which they are specified on the command line.
    460      Directories specified on the command line are searched before the
    461      default directories.  All `-L' options apply to all `-l' options,
    462      regardless of the order in which the options appear.  `-L' options
    463      do not affect how `ld' searches for a linker script unless `-T'
    464      option is specified.
    465 
    466      If SEARCHDIR begins with `=', then the `=' will be replaced by the
    467      "sysroot prefix", controlled by the `--sysroot' option, or
    468      specified when the linker is configured.
    469 
    470      The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
    471      `-L') depends on which emulation mode `ld' is using, and in some
    472      cases also on how it was configured.  *Note Environment::.
    473 
    474      The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
    475      `SEARCH_DIR' command.  Directories specified this way are searched
    476      at the point in which the linker script appears in the command
    477      line.
    478 
    479 `-m EMULATION'
    480      Emulate the EMULATION linker.  You can list the available
    481      emulations with the `--verbose' or `-V' options.
    482 
    483      If the `-m' option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
    484      `LDEMULATION' environment variable, if that is defined.
    485 
    486      Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
    487      configured.
    488 
    489 `-M'
    490 `--print-map'
    491      Print a link map to the standard output.  A link map provides
    492      information about the link, including the following:
    493 
    494         * Where object files are mapped into memory.
    495 
    496         * How common symbols are allocated.
    497 
    498         * All archive members included in the link, with a mention of
    499           the symbol which caused the archive member to be brought in.
    500 
    501         * The values assigned to symbols.
    502 
    503           Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression
    504           which involves a reference to a previous value of the same
    505           symbol may not have correct result displayed in the link map.
    506           This is because the linker discards intermediate results and
    507           only retains the final value of an expression.  Under such
    508           circumstances the linker will display the final value
    509           enclosed by square brackets.  Thus for example a linker
    510           script containing:
    511 
    512                   foo = 1
    513                   foo = foo * 4
    514                   foo = foo + 8
    515 
    516           will produce the following output in the link map if the `-M'
    517           option is used:
    518 
    519                   0x00000001                foo = 0x1
    520                   [0x0000000c]                foo = (foo * 0x4)
    521                   [0x0000000c]                foo = (foo + 0x8)
    522 
    523           See *Note Expressions:: for more information about
    524           expressions in linker scripts.
    525 
    526 `-n'
    527 `--nmagic'
    528      Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against
    529      shared libraries.  If the output format supports Unix style magic
    530      numbers, mark the output as `NMAGIC'.
    531 
    532 `-N'
    533 `--omagic'
    534      Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable.  Also,
    535      do not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against
    536      shared libraries.  If the output format supports Unix style magic
    537      numbers, mark the output as `OMAGIC'. Note: Although a writable
    538      text section is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform
    539      to the format specification published by Microsoft.
    540 
    541 `--no-omagic'
    542      This option negates most of the effects of the `-N' option.  It
    543      sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment
    544      to be page-aligned.  Note - this option does not enable linking
    545      against shared libraries.  Use `-Bdynamic' for this.
    546 
    547 `-o OUTPUT'
    548 `--output=OUTPUT'
    549      Use OUTPUT as the name for the program produced by `ld'; if this
    550      option is not specified, the name `a.out' is used by default.  The
    551      script command `OUTPUT' can also specify the output file name.
    552 
    553 `-O LEVEL'
    554      If LEVEL is a numeric values greater than zero `ld' optimizes the
    555      output.  This might take significantly longer and therefore
    556      probably should only be enabled for the final binary.  At the
    557      moment this option only affects ELF shared library generation.
    558      Future releases of the linker may make more use of this option.
    559      Also currently there is no difference in the linker's behaviour
    560      for different non-zero values of this option.  Again this may
    561      change with future releases.
    562 
    563 `--push-state'
    564      The `--push-state' allows to preserve the current state of the
    565      flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
    566      restored with one corresponding `--pop-state' option.
    567 
    568      The option which are covered are: `-Bdynamic', `-Bstatic', `-dn',
    569      `-dy', `-call_shared', `-non_shared', `-static', `-N', `-n',
    570      `--whole-archive', `--no-whole-archive', `-r', `-Ur',
    571      `--copy-dt-needed-entries', `--no-copy-dt-needed-entries',
    572      `--as-needed', `--no-as-needed', and `-a'.
    573 
    574      One target for this option are specifications for `pkg-config'.
    575      When used with the `--libs' option all possibly needed libraries
    576      are listed and then possibly linked with all the time.  It is
    577      better to return something as follows:
    578 
    579           -Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
    580 
    581      Undoes the effect of -push-state, restores the previous values of
    582      the flags governing input file handling.
    583 
    584 `-q'
    585 `--emit-relocs'
    586      Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
    587      Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this
    588      information in order to perform correct modifications of
    589      executables.  This results in larger executables.
    590 
    591      This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
    592 
    593 `--force-dynamic'
    594      Force the output file to have dynamic sections.  This option is
    595      specific to VxWorks targets.
    596 
    597 `-r'
    598 `--relocatable'
    599      Generate relocatable output--i.e., generate an output file that
    600      can in turn serve as input to `ld'.  This is often called "partial
    601      linking".  As a side effect, in environments that support standard
    602      Unix magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic
    603      number to `OMAGIC'.  If this option is not specified, an absolute
    604      file is produced.  When linking C++ programs, this option _will
    605      not_ resolve references to constructors; to do that, use `-Ur'.
    606 
    607      When an input file does not have the same format as the output
    608      file, partial linking is only supported if that input file does
    609      not contain any relocations.  Different output formats can have
    610      further restrictions; for example some `a.out'-based formats do
    611      not support partial linking with input files in other formats at
    612      all.
    613 
    614      This option does the same thing as `-i'.
    615 
    616 `-R FILENAME'
    617 `--just-symbols=FILENAME'
    618      Read symbol names and their addresses from FILENAME, but do not
    619      relocate it or include it in the output.  This allows your output
    620      file to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined
    621      in other programs.  You may use this option more than once.
    622 
    623      For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the `-R' option is
    624      followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is
    625      treated as the `-rpath' option.
    626 
    627 `-s'
    628 `--strip-all'
    629      Omit all symbol information from the output file.
    630 
    631 `-S'
    632 `--strip-debug'
    633      Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the
    634      output file.
    635 
    636 `-t'
    637 `--trace'
    638      Print the names of the input files as `ld' processes them.
    639 
    640 `-T SCRIPTFILE'
    641 `--script=SCRIPTFILE'
    642      Use SCRIPTFILE as the linker script.  This script replaces `ld''s
    643      default linker script (rather than adding to it), so COMMANDFILE
    644      must specify everything necessary to describe the output file.
    645      *Note Scripts::.  If SCRIPTFILE does not exist in the current
    646      directory, `ld' looks for it in the directories specified by any
    647      preceding `-L' options.  Multiple `-T' options accumulate.
    648 
    649 `-dT SCRIPTFILE'
    650 `--default-script=SCRIPTFILE'
    651      Use SCRIPTFILE as the default linker script.  *Note Scripts::.
    652 
    653      This option is similar to the `--script' option except that
    654      processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
    655      command line has been processed.  This allows options placed after
    656      the `--default-script' option on the command line to affect the
    657      behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the
    658      linker command line cannot be directly controlled by the user.
    659      (eg because the command line is being constructed by another tool,
    660      such as `gcc').
    661 
    662 `-u SYMBOL'
    663 `--undefined=SYMBOL'
    664      Force SYMBOL to be entered in the output file as an undefined
    665      symbol.  Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
    666      modules from standard libraries.  `-u' may be repeated with
    667      different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols.
    668      This option is equivalent to the `EXTERN' linker script command.
    669 
    670 `-Ur'
    671      For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
    672      `-r': it generates relocatable output--i.e., an output file that
    673      can in turn serve as input to `ld'.  When linking C++ programs,
    674      `-Ur' _does_ resolve references to constructors, unlike `-r'.  It
    675      does not work to use `-Ur' on files that were themselves linked
    676      with `-Ur'; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
    677      be added to.  Use `-Ur' only for the last partial link, and `-r'
    678      for the others.
    679 
    680 `--unique[=SECTION]'
    681      Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
    682      SECTION, or if the optional wildcard SECTION argument is missing,
    683      for every orphan input section.  An orphan section is one not
    684      specifically mentioned in a linker script.  You may use this option
    685      multiple times on the command line;  It prevents the normal
    686      merging of input sections with the same name, overriding output
    687      section assignments in a linker script.
    688 
    689 `-v'
    690 `--version'
    691 `-V'
    692      Display the version number for `ld'.  The `-V' option also lists
    693      the supported emulations.
    694 
    695 `-x'
    696 `--discard-all'
    697      Delete all local symbols.
    698 
    699 `-X'
    700 `--discard-locals'
    701      Delete all temporary local symbols.  (These symbols start with
    702      system-specific local label prefixes, typically `.L' for ELF
    703      systems or `L' for traditional a.out systems.)
    704 
    705 `-y SYMBOL'
    706 `--trace-symbol=SYMBOL'
    707      Print the name of each linked file in which SYMBOL appears.  This
    708      option may be given any number of times.  On many systems it is
    709      necessary to prepend an underscore.
    710 
    711      This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your
    712      link but don't know where the reference is coming from.
    713 
    714 `-Y PATH'
    715      Add PATH to the default library search path.  This option exists
    716      for Solaris compatibility.
    717 
    718 `-z KEYWORD'
    719      The recognized keywords are:
    720     `combreloc'
    721           Combines multiple reloc sections and sorts them to make
    722           dynamic symbol lookup caching possible.
    723 
    724     `defs'
    725           Disallows undefined symbols in object files.  Undefined
    726           symbols in shared libraries are still allowed.
    727 
    728     `execstack'
    729           Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
    730 
    731     `global'
    732           This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
    733           It makes the symbols defined by this shared object available
    734           for symbol resolution of subsequently loaded libraries.
    735 
    736     `initfirst'
    737           This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
    738           It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will
    739           occur before the runtime initialization of any other objects
    740           brought into the process at the same time.  Similarly the
    741           runtime finalization of the object will occur after the
    742           runtime finalization of any other objects.
    743 
    744     `interpose'
    745           Marks the object that its symbol table interposes before all
    746           symbols but the primary executable.
    747 
    748     `lazy'
    749           When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to
    750           tell the dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to
    751           the point when the function is called (lazy binding), rather
    752           than at load time.  Lazy binding is the default.
    753 
    754     `loadfltr'
    755           Marks  the object that its filters be processed immediately at
    756           runtime.
    757 
    758     `muldefs'
    759           Allows multiple definitions.
    760 
    761     `nocombreloc'
    762           Disables multiple reloc sections combining.
    763 
    764     `nocopyreloc'
    765           Disables production of copy relocs.
    766 
    767     `nodefaultlib'
    768           Marks the object that the search for dependencies of this
    769           object will ignore any default library search paths.
    770 
    771     `nodelete'
    772           Marks the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
    773 
    774     `nodlopen'
    775           Marks the object not available to `dlopen'.
    776 
    777     `nodump'
    778           Marks the object can not be dumped by `dldump'.
    779 
    780     `noexecstack'
    781           Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
    782 
    783     `norelro'
    784           Don't create an ELF `PT_GNU_RELRO' segment header in the
    785           object.
    786 
    787     `now'
    788           When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to
    789           tell the dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the
    790           program is started, or when the shared library is linked to
    791           using dlopen, instead of deferring function call resolution
    792           to the point when the function is first called.
    793 
    794     `origin'
    795           Marks the object may contain $ORIGIN.
    796 
    797     `relro'
    798           Create an ELF `PT_GNU_RELRO' segment header in the object.
    799 
    800     `max-page-size=VALUE'
    801           Set the emulation maximum page size to VALUE.
    802 
    803     `common-page-size=VALUE'
    804           Set the emulation common page size to VALUE.
    805 
    806     `stack-size=VALUE'
    807           Specify a stack size for in an ELF `PT_GNU_STACK' segment.
    808           Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
    809           `PT_GNU_STACK' segment creation.
    810 
    811     `bndplt'
    812           Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for
    813           Linux/x86_64.
    814 
    815 
    816      Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
    817 
    818 `-( ARCHIVES -)'
    819 `--start-group ARCHIVES --end-group'
    820      The ARCHIVES should be a list of archive files.  They may be
    821      either explicit file names, or `-l' options.
    822 
    823      The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new
    824      undefined references are created.  Normally, an archive is
    825      searched only once in the order that it is specified on the
    826      command line.  If a symbol in that archive is needed to resolve an
    827      undefined symbol referred to by an object in an archive that
    828      appears later on the command line, the linker would not be able to
    829      resolve that reference.  By grouping the archives, they all be
    830      searched repeatedly until all possible references are resolved.
    831 
    832      Using this option has a significant performance cost.  It is best
    833      to use it only when there are unavoidable circular references
    834      between two or more archives.
    835 
    836 `--accept-unknown-input-arch'
    837 `--no-accept-unknown-input-arch'
    838      Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
    839      recognised.  The assumption is that the user knows what they are
    840      doing and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files.
    841      This was the default behaviour of the linker, before release
    842      2.14.  The default behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to
    843      reject such input files, and so the `--accept-unknown-input-arch'
    844      option has been added to restore the old behaviour.
    845 
    846 `--as-needed'
    847 `--no-as-needed'
    848      This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries
    849      mentioned on the command line after the `--as-needed' option.
    850      Normally the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic
    851      library mentioned on the command line, regardless of whether the
    852      library is actually needed or not.  `--as-needed' causes a
    853      DT_NEEDED tag to only be emitted for a library that _at that point
    854      in the link_ satisfies a non-weak undefined symbol reference from
    855      a regular object file or, if the library is not found in the
    856      DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a non-weak undefined
    857      symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.  Object
    858      files or libraries appearing on the command line _after_ the
    859      library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
    860      needed.  This is similar to the rules for extraction of object
    861      files from archives.  `--no-as-needed' restores the default
    862      behaviour.
    863 
    864 `--add-needed'
    865 `--no-add-needed'
    866      These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
    867      their names to the `--as-needed' and `--no-as-needed' options.
    868      They have been replaced by `--copy-dt-needed-entries' and
    869      `--no-copy-dt-needed-entries'.
    870 
    871 `-assert KEYWORD'
    872      This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
    873 
    874 `-Bdynamic'
    875 `-dy'
    876 `-call_shared'
    877      Link against dynamic libraries.  This is only meaningful on
    878      platforms for which shared libraries are supported.  This option
    879      is normally the default on such platforms.  The different variants
    880      of this option are for compatibility with various systems.  You
    881      may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
    882      library searching for `-l' options which follow it.
    883 
    884 `-Bgroup'
    885      Set the `DF_1_GROUP' flag in the `DT_FLAGS_1' entry in the dynamic
    886      section.  This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
    887      object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
    888      `--unresolved-symbols=report-all' is implied.  This option is only
    889      meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
    890 
    891 `-Bstatic'
    892 `-dn'
    893 `-non_shared'
    894 `-static'
    895      Do not link against shared libraries.  This is only meaningful on
    896      platforms for which shared libraries are supported.  The different
    897      variants of this option are for compatibility with various
    898      systems.  You may use this option multiple times on the command
    899      line: it affects library searching for `-l' options which follow
    900      it.  This option also implies `--unresolved-symbols=report-all'.
    901      This option can be used with `-shared'.  Doing so means that a
    902      shared library is being created but that all of the library's
    903      external references must be resolved by pulling in entries from
    904      static libraries.
    905 
    906 `-Bsymbolic'
    907      When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols
    908      to the definition within the shared library, if any.  Normally, it
    909      is possible for a program linked against a shared library to
    910      override the definition within the shared library.  This option is
    911      only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
    912 
    913 `-Bsymbolic-functions'
    914      When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
    915      symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.  This
    916      option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
    917      libraries.
    918 
    919 `--dynamic-list=DYNAMIC-LIST-FILE'
    920      Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker.  This is
    921      typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
    922      global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the
    923      definition within the shared library, or creating dynamically
    924      linked executables to specify a list of symbols which should be
    925      added to the symbol table in the executable.  This option is only
    926      meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
    927 
    928      The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node
    929      without scope and node name.  See *Note VERSION:: for more
    930      information.
    931 
    932 `--dynamic-list-data'
    933      Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
    934 
    935 `--dynamic-list-cpp-new'
    936      Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete.
    937      It is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
    938 
    939 `--dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo'
    940      Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type
    941      identification.
    942 
    943 `--check-sections'
    944 `--no-check-sections'
    945      Asks the linker _not_ to check section addresses after they have
    946      been assigned to see if there are any overlaps.  Normally the
    947      linker will perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it
    948      will produce suitable error messages.  The linker does know about,
    949      and does make allowances for sections in overlays.  The default
    950      behaviour can be restored by using the command line switch
    951      `--check-sections'.  Section overlap is not usually checked for
    952      relocatable links.  You can force checking in that case by using
    953      the `--check-sections' option.
    954 
    955 `--copy-dt-needed-entries'
    956 `--no-copy-dt-needed-entries'
    957      This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
    958      by DT_NEEDED tags _inside_ ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
    959      command line.  Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
    960      output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
    961      input dynamic library.  With `--copy-dt-needed-entries' specified
    962      on the command line however any dynamic libraries that follow it
    963      will have their DT_NEEDED entries added.  The default behaviour
    964      can be restored with `--no-copy-dt-needed-entries'.
    965 
    966      This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in
    967      dynamic libraries.  With `--copy-dt-needed-entries' dynamic
    968      libraries mentioned on the command line will be recursively
    969      searched, following their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in
    970      order to resolve symbols required by the output binary.  With the
    971      default setting however the searching of dynamic libraries that
    972      follow it will stop with the dynamic library itself.  No DT_NEEDED
    973      links will be traversed to resolve symbols.
    974 
    975 `--cref'
    976      Output a cross reference table.  If a linker map file is being
    977      generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
    978      Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
    979 
    980      The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
    981      easily processed by a script if necessary.  The symbols are
    982      printed out, sorted by name.  For each symbol, a list of file
    983      names is given.  If the symbol is defined, the first file listed
    984      is the location of the definition.  If the symbol is defined as a
    985      common value then any files where this happens appear next.
    986      Finally any files that reference the symbol are listed.
    987 
    988 `--no-define-common'
    989      This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
    990      The script command `INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION' has the same effect.
    991      *Note Miscellaneous Commands::.
    992 
    993      The `--no-define-common' option allows decoupling the decision to
    994      assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice of the output
    995      file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type forces
    996      assigning addresses to Common symbols.  Using `--no-define-common'
    997      allows Common symbols that are referenced from a shared library to
    998      be assigned addresses only in the main program.  This eliminates
    999      the unused duplicate space in the shared library, and also
   1000      prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
   1001      duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized
   1002      search paths for runtime symbol resolution.
   1003 
   1004 `--defsym=SYMBOL=EXPRESSION'
   1005      Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
   1006      address given by EXPRESSION.  You may use this option as many
   1007      times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line.
   1008      A limited form of arithmetic is supported for the EXPRESSION in
   1009      this context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of
   1010      an existing symbol, or use `+' and `-' to add or subtract
   1011      hexadecimal constants or symbols.  If you need more elaborate
   1012      expressions, consider using the linker command language from a
   1013      script (*note Assignment: Symbol Definitions: Assignments.).
   1014      _Note:_ there should be no white space between SYMBOL, the equals
   1015      sign ("<=>"), and EXPRESSION.
   1016 
   1017 `--demangle[=STYLE]'
   1018 `--no-demangle'
   1019      These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error
   1020      messages and other output.  When the linker is told to demangle,
   1021      it tries to present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips
   1022      leading underscores if they are used by the object file format,
   1023      and converts C++ mangled symbol names into user readable names.
   1024      Different compilers have different mangling styles.  The optional
   1025      demangling style argument can be used to choose an appropriate
   1026      demangling style for your compiler.  The linker will demangle by
   1027      default unless the environment variable `COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE' is
   1028      set.  These options may be used to override the default.
   1029 
   1030 `-IFILE'
   1031 `--dynamic-linker=FILE'
   1032      Set the name of the dynamic linker.  This is only meaningful when
   1033      generating dynamically linked ELF executables.  The default dynamic
   1034      linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what
   1035      you are doing.
   1036 
   1037 `--fatal-warnings'
   1038 `--no-fatal-warnings'
   1039      Treat all warnings as errors.  The default behaviour can be
   1040      restored with the option `--no-fatal-warnings'.
   1041 
   1042 `--force-exe-suffix'
   1043      Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
   1044 
   1045      If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
   1046      `.exe' or `.dll' suffix, this option forces the linker to copy the
   1047      output file to one of the same name with a `.exe' suffix. This
   1048      option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a
   1049      Microsoft Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run
   1050      an image unless it ends in a `.exe' suffix.
   1051 
   1052 `--gc-sections'
   1053 `--no-gc-sections'
   1054      Enable garbage collection of unused input sections.  It is ignored
   1055      on targets that do not support this option.  The default behaviour
   1056      (of not performing this garbage collection) can be restored by
   1057      specifying `--no-gc-sections' on the command line.
   1058 
   1059      `--gc-sections' decides which input sections are used by examining
   1060      symbols and relocations.  The section containing the entry symbol
   1061      and all sections containing symbols undefined on the command-line
   1062      will be kept, as will sections containing symbols referenced by
   1063      dynamic objects.  Note that when building shared libraries, the
   1064      linker must assume that any visible symbol is referenced.  Once
   1065      this initial set of sections has been determined, the linker
   1066      recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
   1067      relocations.  See `--entry' and `--undefined'.
   1068 
   1069      This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with
   1070      option `-r').  In this case the root of symbols kept must be
   1071      explicitly specified either by an `--entry' or `--undefined'
   1072      option or by a `ENTRY' command in the linker script.
   1073 
   1074 `--print-gc-sections'
   1075 `--no-print-gc-sections'
   1076      List all sections removed by garbage collection.  The listing is
   1077      printed on stderr.  This option is only effective if garbage
   1078      collection has been enabled via the `--gc-sections') option.  The
   1079      default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed)
   1080      can be restored by specifying `--no-print-gc-sections' on the
   1081      command line.
   1082 
   1083 `--print-output-format'
   1084      Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
   1085      other command-line options).  This is the string that would appear
   1086      in an `OUTPUT_FORMAT' linker script command (*note File
   1087      Commands::).
   1088 
   1089 `--help'
   1090      Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output
   1091      and exit.
   1092 
   1093 `--target-help'
   1094      Print a summary of all target specific options on the standard
   1095      output and exit.
   1096 
   1097 `-Map=MAPFILE'
   1098      Print a link map to the file MAPFILE.  See the description of the
   1099      `-M' option, above.
   1100 
   1101 `--no-keep-memory'
   1102      `ld' normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
   1103      symbol tables of input files in memory.  This option tells `ld' to
   1104      instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables
   1105      as necessary.  This may be required if `ld' runs out of memory
   1106      space while linking a large executable.
   1107 
   1108 `--no-undefined'
   1109 `-z defs'
   1110      Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files.
   1111      This is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared
   1112      library.  The switch `--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined' controls the
   1113      behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
   1114      libraries being linked in.
   1115 
   1116 `--allow-multiple-definition'
   1117 `-z muldefs'
   1118      Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
   1119      report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and
   1120      the first definition will be used.
   1121 
   1122 `--allow-shlib-undefined'
   1123 `--no-allow-shlib-undefined'
   1124      Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.  This
   1125      switch is similar to `--no-undefined' except that it determines
   1126      the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a shared library
   1127      rather than a regular object file.  It does not affect how
   1128      undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
   1129 
   1130      The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
   1131      referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to
   1132      create an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being
   1133      used to create a shared library.
   1134 
   1135      The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
   1136      libraries specified at link time are that:
   1137 
   1138         * A shared library specified at link time may not be the same
   1139           as the one that is available at load time, so the symbol
   1140           might actually be resolvable at load time.
   1141 
   1142         * There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where
   1143           undefined symbols in shared libraries are normal.
   1144 
   1145           The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load
   1146           time to select whichever function is most appropriate for the
   1147           current architecture.  This is used, for example, to
   1148           dynamically select an appropriate memset function.
   1149 
   1150 `--no-undefined-version'
   1151      Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will
   1152      ignore it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version
   1153      and a fatal error will be issued instead.
   1154 
   1155 `--default-symver'
   1156      Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for
   1157      unversioned exported symbols.
   1158 
   1159 `--default-imported-symver'
   1160      Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for
   1161      unversioned imported symbols.
   1162 
   1163 `--no-warn-mismatch'
   1164      Normally `ld' will give an error if you try to link together input
   1165      files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they
   1166      have been compiled for different processors or for different
   1167      endiannesses.  This option tells `ld' that it should silently
   1168      permit such possible errors.  This option should only be used with
   1169      care, in cases when you have taken some special action that
   1170      ensures that the linker errors are inappropriate.
   1171 
   1172 `--no-warn-search-mismatch'
   1173      Normally `ld' will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
   1174      library during a library search.  This option silences the warning.
   1175 
   1176 `--no-whole-archive'
   1177      Turn off the effect of the `--whole-archive' option for subsequent
   1178      archive files.
   1179 
   1180 `--noinhibit-exec'
   1181      Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
   1182      Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it
   1183      encounters errors during the link process; it exits without
   1184      writing an output file when it issues any error whatsoever.
   1185 
   1186 `-nostdlib'
   1187      Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
   1188      command line.  Library directories specified in linker scripts
   1189      (including linker scripts specified on the command line) are
   1190      ignored.
   1191 
   1192 `--oformat=OUTPUT-FORMAT'
   1193      `ld' may be configured to support more than one kind of object
   1194      file.  If your `ld' is configured this way, you can use the
   1195      `--oformat' option to specify the binary format for the output
   1196      object file.  Even when `ld' is configured to support alternative
   1197      object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as `ld'
   1198      should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
   1199      usual format on each machine.  OUTPUT-FORMAT is a text string, the
   1200      name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries.  (You
   1201      can list the available binary formats with `objdump -i'.)  The
   1202      script command `OUTPUT_FORMAT' can also specify the output format,
   1203      but this option overrides it.  *Note BFD::.
   1204 
   1205 `-pie'
   1206 `--pic-executable'
   1207      Create a position independent executable.  This is currently only
   1208      supported on ELF platforms.  Position independent executables are
   1209      similar to shared libraries in that they are relocated by the
   1210      dynamic linker to the virtual address the OS chooses for them
   1211      (which can vary between invocations).  Like normal dynamically
   1212      linked executables they can be executed and symbols defined in the
   1213      executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
   1214 
   1215 `-qmagic'
   1216      This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
   1217 
   1218 `-Qy'
   1219      This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
   1220 
   1221 `--relax'
   1222 `--no-relax'
   1223      An option with machine dependent effects.  This option is only
   1224      supported on a few targets.  *Note `ld' and the H8/300: H8/300.
   1225      *Note `ld' and the Intel 960 family: i960.  *Note `ld' and Xtensa
   1226      Processors: Xtensa.  *Note `ld' and the 68HC11 and 68HC12:
   1227      M68HC11/68HC12.  *Note `ld' and the Altera Nios II: Nios II.
   1228      *Note `ld' and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support: PowerPC ELF32.
   1229 
   1230      On some platforms the `--relax' option performs target specific,
   1231      global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
   1232      addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
   1233      synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
   1234      instructions, and combining constant values.
   1235 
   1236      On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make
   1237      symbolic debugging of the resulting executable impossible.  This
   1238      is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
   1239      family of processors.
   1240 
   1241      On platforms where this is not supported, `--relax' is accepted,
   1242      but ignored.
   1243 
   1244      On platforms where `--relax' is accepted the option `--no-relax'
   1245      can be used to disable the feature.
   1246 
   1247 `--retain-symbols-file=FILENAME'
   1248      Retain _only_ the symbols listed in the file FILENAME, discarding
   1249      all others.  FILENAME is simply a flat file, with one symbol name
   1250      per line.  This option is especially useful in environments (such
   1251      as VxWorks) where a large global symbol table is accumulated
   1252      gradually, to conserve run-time memory.
   1253 
   1254      `--retain-symbols-file' does _not_ discard undefined symbols, or
   1255      symbols needed for relocations.
   1256 
   1257      You may only specify `--retain-symbols-file' once in the command
   1258      line.  It overrides `-s' and `-S'.
   1259 
   1260 `-rpath=DIR'
   1261      Add a directory to the runtime library search path.  This is used
   1262      when linking an ELF executable with shared objects.  All `-rpath'
   1263      arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which
   1264      uses them to locate shared objects at runtime.  The `-rpath'
   1265      option is also used when locating shared objects which are needed
   1266      by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
   1267      description of the `-rpath-link' option.  If `-rpath' is not used
   1268      when linking an ELF executable, the contents of the environment
   1269      variable `LD_RUN_PATH' will be used if it is defined.
   1270 
   1271      The `-rpath' option may also be used on SunOS.  By default, on
   1272      SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search patch out of all the
   1273      `-L' options it is given.  If a `-rpath' option is used, the
   1274      runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the `-rpath'
   1275      options, ignoring the `-L' options.  This can be useful when using
   1276      gcc, which adds many `-L' options which may be on NFS mounted file
   1277      systems.
   1278 
   1279      For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the `-R' option is
   1280      followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is
   1281      treated as the `-rpath' option.
   1282 
   1283 `-rpath-link=DIR'
   1284      When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another.
   1285      This happens when an `ld -shared' link includes a shared library
   1286      as one of the input files.
   1287 
   1288      When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a
   1289      non-shared, non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to
   1290      locate the required shared library and include it in the link, if
   1291      it is not included explicitly.  In such a case, the `-rpath-link'
   1292      option specifies the first set of directories to search.  The
   1293      `-rpath-link' option may specify a sequence of directory names
   1294      either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
   1295      appearing multiple times.
   1296 
   1297      This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search
   1298      path that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In
   1299      such a case it is possible to use unintentionally a different
   1300      search path than the runtime linker would do.
   1301 
   1302      The linker uses the following search paths to locate required
   1303      shared libraries:
   1304        1. Any directories specified by `-rpath-link' options.
   1305 
   1306        2. Any directories specified by `-rpath' options.  The difference
   1307           between `-rpath' and `-rpath-link' is that directories
   1308           specified by `-rpath' options are included in the executable
   1309           and used at runtime, whereas the `-rpath-link' option is only
   1310           effective at link time. Searching `-rpath' in this way is
   1311           only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which have
   1312           been configured with the `--with-sysroot' option.
   1313 
   1314        3. On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the `-rpath' and
   1315           `-rpath-link' options were not used, search the contents of
   1316           the environment variable `LD_RUN_PATH'.
   1317 
   1318        4. On SunOS, if the `-rpath' option was not used, search any
   1319           directories specified using `-L' options.
   1320 
   1321        5. For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
   1322           variable `LD_LIBRARY_PATH'.
   1323 
   1324        6. For a native ELF linker, the directories in `DT_RUNPATH' or
   1325           `DT_RPATH' of a shared library are searched for shared
   1326           libraries needed by it. The `DT_RPATH' entries are ignored if
   1327           `DT_RUNPATH' entries exist.
   1328 
   1329        7. The default directories, normally `/lib' and `/usr/lib'.
   1330 
   1331        8. For a native linker on an ELF system, if the file
   1332           `/etc/ld.so.conf' exists, the list of directories found in
   1333           that file.
   1334 
   1335      If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue
   1336      a warning and continue with the link.
   1337 
   1338 `-shared'
   1339 `-Bshareable'
   1340      Create a shared library.  This is currently only supported on ELF,
   1341      XCOFF and SunOS platforms.  On SunOS, the linker will
   1342      automatically create a shared library if the `-e' option is not
   1343      used and there are undefined symbols in the link.
   1344 
   1345 `--sort-common'
   1346 `--sort-common=ascending'
   1347 `--sort-common=descending'
   1348      This option tells `ld' to sort the common symbols by alignment in
   1349      ascending or descending order when it places them in the
   1350      appropriate output sections.  The symbol alignments considered are
   1351      sixteen-byte or larger, eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and
   1352      one-byte. This is to prevent gaps between symbols due to alignment
   1353      constraints.  If no sorting order is specified, then descending
   1354      order is assumed.
   1355 
   1356 `--sort-section=name'
   1357      This option will apply `SORT_BY_NAME' to all wildcard section
   1358      patterns in the linker script.
   1359 
   1360 `--sort-section=alignment'
   1361      This option will apply `SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT' to all wildcard section
   1362      patterns in the linker script.
   1363 
   1364 `--split-by-file[=SIZE]'
   1365      Similar to `--split-by-reloc' but creates a new output section for
   1366      each input file when SIZE is reached.  SIZE defaults to a size of
   1367      1 if not given.
   1368 
   1369 `--split-by-reloc[=COUNT]'
   1370      Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no
   1371      single output section in the file contains more than COUNT
   1372      relocations.  This is useful when generating huge relocatable
   1373      files for downloading into certain real time kernels with the COFF
   1374      object file format; since COFF cannot represent more than 65535
   1375      relocations in a single section.  Note that this will fail to work
   1376      with object file formats which do not support arbitrary sections.
   1377      The linker will not split up individual input sections for
   1378      redistribution, so if a single input section contains more than
   1379      COUNT relocations one output section will contain that many
   1380      relocations.  COUNT defaults to a value of 32768.
   1381 
   1382 `--stats'
   1383      Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker,
   1384      such as execution time and memory usage.
   1385 
   1386 `--sysroot=DIRECTORY'
   1387      Use DIRECTORY as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
   1388      configure-time default.  This option is only supported by linkers
   1389      that were configured using `--with-sysroot'.
   1390 
   1391 `--traditional-format'
   1392      For some targets, the output of `ld' is different in some ways from
   1393      the output of some existing linker.  This switch requests `ld' to
   1394      use the traditional format instead.
   1395 
   1396      For example, on SunOS, `ld' combines duplicate entries in the
   1397      symbol string table.  This can reduce the size of an output file
   1398      with full debugging information by over 30 percent.
   1399      Unfortunately, the SunOS `dbx' program can not read the resulting
   1400      program (`gdb' has no trouble).  The `--traditional-format' switch
   1401      tells `ld' to not combine duplicate entries.
   1402 
   1403 `--section-start=SECTIONNAME=ORG'
   1404      Locate a section in the output file at the absolute address given
   1405      by ORG.  You may use this option as many times as necessary to
   1406      locate multiple sections in the command line.  ORG must be a
   1407      single hexadecimal integer; for compatibility with other linkers,
   1408      you may omit the leading `0x' usually associated with hexadecimal
   1409      values.  _Note:_ there should be no white space between
   1410      SECTIONNAME, the equals sign ("<=>"), and ORG.
   1411 
   1412 `-Tbss=ORG'
   1413 `-Tdata=ORG'
   1414 `-Ttext=ORG'
   1415      Same as `--section-start', with `.bss', `.data' or `.text' as the
   1416      SECTIONNAME.
   1417 
   1418 `-Ttext-segment=ORG'
   1419      When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the
   1420      first byte of the text segment.
   1421 
   1422 `-Trodata-segment=ORG'
   1423      When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
   1424      the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the
   1425      executable text, it will set the address of the first byte of the
   1426      read-only data segment.
   1427 
   1428 `-Tldata-segment=ORG'
   1429      When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium
   1430      memory model, it will set the address of the first byte of the
   1431      ldata segment.
   1432 
   1433 `--unresolved-symbols=METHOD'
   1434      Determine how to handle unresolved symbols.  There are four
   1435      possible values for `method':
   1436 
   1437     `ignore-all'
   1438           Do not report any unresolved symbols.
   1439 
   1440     `report-all'
   1441           Report all unresolved symbols.  This is the default.
   1442 
   1443     `ignore-in-object-files'
   1444           Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared
   1445           libraries, but ignore them if they come from regular object
   1446           files.
   1447 
   1448     `ignore-in-shared-libs'
   1449           Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object
   1450           files, but ignore them if they come from shared libraries.
   1451           This can be useful when creating a dynamic binary and it is
   1452           known that all the shared libraries that it should be
   1453           referencing are included on the linker's command line.
   1454 
   1455      The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be
   1456      controlled by the `--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined' option.
   1457 
   1458      Normally the linker will generate an error message for each
   1459      reported unresolved symbol but the option
   1460      `--warn-unresolved-symbols' can change this to a warning.
   1461 
   1462 `--dll-verbose'
   1463 `--verbose[=NUMBER]'
   1464      Display the version number for `ld' and list the linker emulations
   1465      supported.  Display which input files can and cannot be opened.
   1466      Display the linker script being used by the linker. If the
   1467      optional NUMBER argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be
   1468      displayed.
   1469 
   1470 `--version-script=VERSION-SCRIPTFILE'
   1471      Specify the name of a version script to the linker.  This is
   1472      typically used when creating shared libraries to specify
   1473      additional information about the version hierarchy for the library
   1474      being created.  This option is only fully supported on ELF
   1475      platforms which support shared libraries; see *Note VERSION::.  It
   1476      is partially supported on PE platforms, which can use version
   1477      scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
   1478      symbols marked `local' in the version script will not be exported.
   1479      *Note WIN32::.
   1480 
   1481 `--warn-common'
   1482      Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol
   1483      or with a symbol definition.  Unix linkers allow this somewhat
   1484      sloppy practice, but linkers on some other operating systems do
   1485      not.  This option allows you to find potential problems from
   1486      combining global symbols.  Unfortunately, some C libraries use
   1487      this practice, so you may get some warnings about symbols in the
   1488      libraries as well as in your programs.
   1489 
   1490      There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C
   1491      examples:
   1492 
   1493     `int i = 1;'
   1494           A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of
   1495           the output file.
   1496 
   1497     `extern int i;'
   1498           An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.  There
   1499           must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
   1500           variable somewhere.
   1501 
   1502     `int i;'
   1503           A common symbol.  If there are only (one or more) common
   1504           symbols for a variable, it goes in the uninitialized data
   1505           area of the output file.  The linker merges multiple common
   1506           symbols for the same variable into a single symbol.  If they
   1507           are of different sizes, it picks the largest size.  The
   1508           linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
   1509           a definition of the same variable.
   1510 
   1511      The `--warn-common' option can produce five kinds of warnings.
   1512      Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the
   1513      symbol just encountered, and the second describes the previous
   1514      symbol encountered with the same name.  One or both of the two
   1515      symbols will be a common symbol.
   1516 
   1517        1. Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is
   1518           already a definition for the symbol.
   1519                FILE(SECTION): warning: common of `SYMBOL'
   1520                   overridden by definition
   1521                FILE(SECTION): warning: defined here
   1522 
   1523        2. Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later
   1524           definition for the symbol is encountered.  This is the same
   1525           as the previous case, except that the symbols are encountered
   1526           in a different order.
   1527                FILE(SECTION): warning: definition of `SYMBOL'
   1528                   overriding common
   1529                FILE(SECTION): warning: common is here
   1530 
   1531        3. Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common
   1532           symbol.
   1533                FILE(SECTION): warning: multiple common
   1534                   of `SYMBOL'
   1535                FILE(SECTION): warning: previous common is here
   1536 
   1537        4. Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
   1538                FILE(SECTION): warning: common of `SYMBOL'
   1539                   overridden by larger common
   1540                FILE(SECTION): warning: larger common is here
   1541 
   1542        5. Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common
   1543           symbol.  This is the same as the previous case, except that
   1544           the symbols are encountered in a different order.
   1545                FILE(SECTION): warning: common of `SYMBOL'
   1546                   overriding smaller common
   1547                FILE(SECTION): warning: smaller common is here
   1548 
   1549 `--warn-constructors'
   1550      Warn if any global constructors are used.  This is only useful for
   1551      a few object file formats.  For formats like COFF or ELF, the
   1552      linker can not detect the use of global constructors.
   1553 
   1554 `--warn-multiple-gp'
   1555      Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output
   1556      file.  This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the
   1557      Alpha.  Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants
   1558      in a special section.  A special register (the global pointer)
   1559      points into the middle of this section, so that constants can be
   1560      loaded efficiently via a base-register relative addressing mode.
   1561      Since the offset in base-register relative mode is fixed and
   1562      relatively small (e.g., 16 bits), this limits the maximum size of
   1563      the constant pool.  Thus, in large programs, it is often necessary
   1564      to use multiple global pointer values in order to be able to
   1565      address all possible constants.  This option causes a warning to
   1566      be issued whenever this case occurs.
   1567 
   1568 `--warn-once'
   1569      Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per
   1570      module which refers to it.
   1571 
   1572 `--warn-section-align'
   1573      Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
   1574      alignment.  Typically, the alignment will be set by an input
   1575      section.  The address will only be changed if it not explicitly
   1576      specified; that is, if the `SECTIONS' command does not specify a
   1577      start address for the section (*note SECTIONS::).
   1578 
   1579 `--warn-shared-textrel'
   1580      Warn if the linker adds a DT_TEXTREL to a shared object.
   1581 
   1582 `--warn-alternate-em'
   1583      Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
   1584 
   1585 `--warn-unresolved-symbols'
   1586      If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the
   1587      option `--unresolved-symbols') it will normally generate an error.
   1588      This option makes it generate a warning instead.
   1589 
   1590 `--error-unresolved-symbols'
   1591      This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors
   1592      when it is reporting unresolved symbols.
   1593 
   1594 `--whole-archive'
   1595      For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
   1596      `--whole-archive' option, include every object file in the archive
   1597      in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required
   1598      object files.  This is normally used to turn an archive file into
   1599      a shared library, forcing every object to be included in the
   1600      resulting shared library.  This option may be used more than once.
   1601 
   1602      Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
   1603      about this option, so you have to use `-Wl,-whole-archive'.
   1604      Second, don't forget to use `-Wl,-no-whole-archive' after your
   1605      list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
   1606      your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
   1607 
   1608 `--wrap=SYMBOL'
   1609      Use a wrapper function for SYMBOL.  Any undefined reference to
   1610      SYMBOL will be resolved to `__wrap_SYMBOL'.  Any undefined
   1611      reference to `__real_SYMBOL' will be resolved to SYMBOL.
   1612 
   1613      This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function.  The
   1614      wrapper function should be called `__wrap_SYMBOL'.  If it wishes
   1615      to call the system function, it should call `__real_SYMBOL'.
   1616 
   1617      Here is a trivial example:
   1618 
   1619           void *
   1620           __wrap_malloc (size_t c)
   1621           {
   1622             printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
   1623             return __real_malloc (c);
   1624           }
   1625 
   1626      If you link other code with this file using `--wrap malloc', then
   1627      all calls to `malloc' will call the function `__wrap_malloc'
   1628      instead.  The call to `__real_malloc' in `__wrap_malloc' will call
   1629      the real `malloc' function.
   1630 
   1631      You may wish to provide a `__real_malloc' function as well, so that
   1632      links without the `--wrap' option will succeed.  If you do this,
   1633      you should not put the definition of `__real_malloc' in the same
   1634      file as `__wrap_malloc'; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
   1635      call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to `malloc'.
   1636 
   1637 `--eh-frame-hdr'
   1638      Request creation of `.eh_frame_hdr' section and ELF
   1639      `PT_GNU_EH_FRAME' segment header.
   1640 
   1641 `--no-ld-generated-unwind-info'
   1642      Request creation of `.eh_frame' unwind info for linker generated
   1643      code sections like PLT.  This option is on by default if linker
   1644      generated unwind info is supported.
   1645 
   1646 `--enable-new-dtags'
   1647 `--disable-new-dtags'
   1648      This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older
   1649      ELF systems may not understand them. If you specify
   1650      `--enable-new-dtags', the new dynamic tags will be created as
   1651      needed and older dynamic tags will be omitted.  If you specify
   1652      `--disable-new-dtags', no new dynamic tags will be created. By
   1653      default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that those
   1654      options are only available for ELF systems.
   1655 
   1656 `--hash-size=NUMBER'
   1657      Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
   1658      close to NUMBER.  Increasing this value can reduce the length of
   1659      time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
   1660      increasing the linker's memory requirements.  Similarly reducing
   1661      this value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of
   1662      speed.
   1663 
   1664 `--hash-style=STYLE'
   1665      Set the type of linker's hash table(s).  STYLE can be either
   1666      `sysv' for classic ELF `.hash' section, `gnu' for new style GNU
   1667      `.gnu.hash' section or `both' for both the classic ELF `.hash' and
   1668      new style GNU `.gnu.hash' hash tables.  The default is `sysv'.
   1669 
   1670 `--reduce-memory-overheads'
   1671      This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the
   1672      expense of linking speed.  This was introduced to select the old
   1673      O(n^2) algorithm for link map file generation, rather than the new
   1674      O(n) algorithm which uses about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
   1675 
   1676      Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size
   1677      to 1021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the
   1678      linker's run time.  This is not done however if the `--hash-size'
   1679      switch has been used.
   1680 
   1681      The `--reduce-memory-overheads' switch may be also be used to
   1682      enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
   1683 
   1684 `--build-id'
   1685 `--build-id=STYLE'
   1686      Request the creation of a `.note.gnu.build-id' ELF note section or
   1687      a `.build-id' COFF section.  The contents of the note are unique
   1688      bits identifying this linked file.  STYLE can be `uuid' to use 128
   1689      random bits, `sha1' to use a 160-bit SHA1 hash on the normative
   1690      parts of the output contents, `md5' to use a 128-bit MD5 hash on
   1691      the normative parts of the output contents, or `0xHEXSTRING' to
   1692      use a chosen bit string specified as an even number of hexadecimal
   1693      digits (`-' and `:' characters between digit pairs are ignored).
   1694      If STYLE is omitted, `sha1' is used.
   1695 
   1696      The `md5' and `sha1' styles produces an identifier that is always
   1697      the same in an identical output file, but will be unique among all
   1698      nonidentical output files.  It is not intended to be compared as a
   1699      checksum for the file's contents.  A linked file may be changed
   1700      later by other tools, but the build ID bit string identifying the
   1701      original linked file does not change.
   1702 
   1703      Passing `none' for STYLE disables the setting from any
   1704      `--build-id' options earlier on the command line.
   1705 
   1706 2.1.1 Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
   1707 -----------------------------------------
   1708 
   1709 The i386 PE linker supports the `-shared' option, which causes the
   1710 output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a normal
   1711 executable.  You should name the output `*.dll' when you use this
   1712 option.  In addition, the linker fully supports the standard `*.def'
   1713 files, which may be specified on the linker command line like an object
   1714 file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports symbols from, to
   1715 ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal object file).
   1716 
   1717    In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
   1718 support additional command line options that are specific to the i386
   1719 PE target.  Options that take values may be separated from their values
   1720 by either a space or an equals sign.
   1721 
   1722 `--add-stdcall-alias'
   1723      If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@NN) will be exported
   1724      as-is and also with the suffix stripped.  [This option is specific
   1725      to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
   1726 
   1727 `--base-file FILE'
   1728      Use FILE as the name of a file in which to save the base addresses
   1729      of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with `dlltool'.
   1730      [This is an i386 PE specific option]
   1731 
   1732 `--dll'
   1733      Create a DLL instead of a regular executable.  You may also use
   1734      `-shared' or specify a `LIBRARY' in a given `.def' file.  [This
   1735      option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
   1736 
   1737 `--enable-long-section-names'
   1738 `--disable-long-section-names'
   1739      The PE variants of the Coff object format add an extension that
   1740      permits the use of section names longer than eight characters, the
   1741      normal limit for Coff.  By default, these names are only allowed
   1742      in object files, as fully-linked executable images do not carry
   1743      the Coff string table required to support the longer names.  As a
   1744      GNU extension, it is possible to allow their use in executable
   1745      images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)  disallow it in
   1746      object files, by using these two options.  Executable images
   1747      generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard,
   1748      carrying as they do a string table, and may generate confusing
   1749      output when examined with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file
   1750      viewers and dumpers.  However, GDB relies on the use of PE long
   1751      section names to find Dwarf-2 debug information sections in an
   1752      executable image at runtime, and so if neither option is specified
   1753      on the command-line, `ld' will enable long section names,
   1754      overriding the default and technically correct behaviour, when it
   1755      finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
   1756      image and not stripping symbols.  [This option is valid for all PE
   1757      targeted ports of the linker]
   1758 
   1759 `--enable-stdcall-fixup'
   1760 `--disable-stdcall-fixup'
   1761      If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt
   1762      to do "fuzzy linking" by looking for another defined symbol that
   1763      differs only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall)
   1764      and will resolve that symbol by linking to the match.  For
   1765      example, the undefined symbol `_foo' might be linked to the
   1766      function `_foo@12', or the undefined symbol `_bar@16' might be
   1767      linked to the function `_bar'.  When the linker does this, it
   1768      prints a warning, since it normally should have failed to link,
   1769      but sometimes import libraries generated from third-party dlls may
   1770      need this feature to be usable.  If you specify
   1771      `--enable-stdcall-fixup', this feature is fully enabled and
   1772      warnings are not printed.  If you specify
   1773      `--disable-stdcall-fixup', this feature is disabled and such
   1774      mismatches are considered to be errors.  [This option is specific
   1775      to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
   1776 
   1777 `--leading-underscore'
   1778 `--no-leading-underscore'
   1779      For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is
   1780      defined in target's description. By this option it is possible to
   1781      disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
   1782 
   1783 `--export-all-symbols'
   1784      If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL
   1785      will be exported by the DLL.  Note that this is the default if
   1786      there otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols.  When symbols are
   1787      explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via
   1788      function attributes, the default is to not export anything else
   1789      unless this option is given.  Note that the symbols `DllMain@12',
   1790      `DllEntryPoint@0', `DllMainCRTStartup@12', and `impure_ptr' will
   1791      not be automatically exported.  Also, symbols imported from other
   1792      DLLs will not be re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the
   1793      DLL's internal layout such as those beginning with `_head_' or
   1794      ending with `_iname'.  In addition, no symbols from `libgcc',
   1795      `libstd++', `libmingw32', or `crtX.o' will be exported.  Symbols
   1796      whose names begin with `__rtti_' or `__builtin_' will not be
   1797      exported, to help with C++ DLLs.  Finally, there is an extensive
   1798      list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported (obviously,
   1799      this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).  These
   1800      cygwin-excludes are: `_cygwin_dll_entry@12',
   1801      `_cygwin_crt0_common@8', `_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@12',
   1802      `_fmode', `_impure_ptr', `cygwin_attach_dll', `cygwin_premain0',
   1803      `cygwin_premain1', `cygwin_premain2', `cygwin_premain3', and
   1804      `environ'.  [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port
   1805      of the linker]
   1806 
   1807 `--exclude-symbols SYMBOL,SYMBOL,...'
   1808      Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
   1809      exported.  The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
   1810      [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the
   1811      linker]
   1812 
   1813 `--exclude-all-symbols'
   1814      Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.  [This
   1815      option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
   1816 
   1817 `--file-alignment'
   1818      Specify the file alignment.  Sections in the file will always
   1819      begin at file offsets which are multiples of this number.  This
   1820      defaults to 512.  [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted
   1821      port of the linker]
   1822 
   1823 `--heap RESERVE'
   1824 `--heap RESERVE,COMMIT'
   1825      Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally
   1826      commit) to be used as heap for this program.  The default is 1MB
   1827      reserved, 4K committed.  [This option is specific to the i386 PE
   1828      targeted port of the linker]
   1829 
   1830 `--image-base VALUE'
   1831      Use VALUE as the base address of your program or dll.  This is the
   1832      lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
   1833      is loaded.  To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance
   1834      of your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not
   1835      overlap any other dlls.  The default is 0x400000 for executables,
   1836      and 0x10000000 for dlls.  [This option is specific to the i386 PE
   1837      targeted port of the linker]
   1838 
   1839 `--kill-at'
   1840      If given, the stdcall suffixes (@NN) will be stripped from symbols
   1841      before they are exported.  [This option is specific to the i386 PE
   1842      targeted port of the linker]
   1843 
   1844 `--large-address-aware'
   1845      If given, the appropriate bit in the "Characteristics" field of
   1846      the COFF header is set to indicate that this executable supports
   1847      virtual addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.  This should be used
   1848      in conjunction with the /3GB or /USERVA=VALUE megabytes switch in
   1849      the "[operating systems]" section of the BOOT.INI.  Otherwise,
   1850      this bit has no effect.  [This option is specific to PE targeted
   1851      ports of the linker]
   1852 
   1853 `--disable-large-address-aware'
   1854      Reverts the effect of a previous `--large-address-aware' option.
   1855      This is useful if `--large-address-aware' is always set by the
   1856      compiler driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not
   1857      support virtual addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.  [This option
   1858      is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
   1859 
   1860 `--major-image-version VALUE'
   1861      Sets the major number of the "image version".  Defaults to 1.
   1862      [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the
   1863      linker]
   1864 
   1865 `--major-os-version VALUE'
   1866      Sets the major number of the "os version".  Defaults to 4.  [This
   1867      option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
   1868 
   1869 `--major-subsystem-version VALUE'
   1870      Sets the major number of the "subsystem version".  Defaults to 4.
   1871      [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the
   1872      linker]
   1873 
   1874 `--minor-image-version VALUE'
   1875      Sets the minor number of the "image version".  Defaults to 0.
   1876      [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the
   1877      linker]
   1878 
   1879 `--minor-os-version VALUE'
   1880      Sets the minor number of the "os version".  Defaults to 0.  [This
   1881      option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
   1882 
   1883 `--minor-subsystem-version VALUE'
   1884      Sets the minor number of the "subsystem version".  Defaults to 0.
   1885      [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the
   1886      linker]
   1887 
   1888 `--output-def FILE'
   1889      The linker will create the file FILE which will contain a DEF file
   1890      corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating.  This DEF file
   1891      (which should be called `*.def') may be used to create an import
   1892      library with `dlltool' or may be used as a reference to
   1893      automatically or implicitly exported symbols.  [This option is
   1894      specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
   1895 
   1896 `--out-implib FILE'
   1897      The linker will create the file FILE which will contain an import
   1898      lib corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This import
   1899      lib (which should be called `*.dll.a' or `*.a' may be used to link
   1900      clients against the generated DLL; this behaviour makes it
   1901      possible to skip a separate `dlltool' import library creation step.
   1902      [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the
   1903      linker]
   1904 
   1905 `--enable-auto-image-base'
   1906 `--enable-auto-image-base=VALUE'
   1907      Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting
   1908      with base VALUE, unless one is specified using the `--image-base'
   1909      argument.  By using a hash generated from the dllname to create
   1910      unique image bases for each DLL, in-memory collisions and
   1911      relocations which can delay program execution are avoided.  [This
   1912      option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
   1913 
   1914 `--disable-auto-image-base'
   1915      Do not automatically generate a unique image base.  If there is no
   1916      user-specified image base (`--image-base') then use the platform
   1917      default.  [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of
   1918      the linker]
   1919 
   1920 `--dll-search-prefix STRING'
   1921      When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
   1922      search for `<string><basename>.dll' in preference to
   1923      `lib<basename>.dll'. This behaviour allows easy distinction
   1924      between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
   1925      uwin, pw, etc.  For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
   1926      `--dll-search-prefix=cyg'.  [This option is specific to the i386
   1927      PE targeted port of the linker]
   1928 
   1929 `--enable-auto-import'
   1930      Do sophisticated linking of `_symbol' to `__imp__symbol' for DATA
   1931      imports from DLLs, and create the necessary thunking symbols when
   1932      building the import libraries with those DATA exports. Note: Use
   1933      of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section of the
   1934      image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
   1935      PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
   1936 
   1937      Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
   1938      data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
   1939      placed into the .data section instead.  This is in order to work
   1940      around a problem with consts that is described here:
   1941      http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
   1942 
   1943      Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' - but sometimes you
   1944      may see this message:
   1945 
   1946      "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
   1947      documentation for ld's `--enable-auto-import' for details."
   1948 
   1949      This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
   1950      ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables
   1951      only allow one).  Instances where this may occur include accesses
   1952      to member fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well
   1953      as using a constant index into an array variable imported from a
   1954      DLL.  Any multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may
   1955      trigger this error condition.  However, regardless of the exact
   1956      data type of the offending exported variable, ld will always
   1957      detect it, issue the warning, and exit.
   1958 
   1959      There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of
   1960      the data type of the exported variable:
   1961 
   1962      One way is to use -enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves
   1963      the task of adjusting references in your client code for runtime
   1964      environment, so this method works only when runtime environment
   1965      supports this feature.
   1966 
   1967      A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a
   1968      variable - that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time.
   1969      For arrays, there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the
   1970      array's address) a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a
   1971      variable.  Thus:
   1972 
   1973           extern type extern_array[];
   1974           extern_array[1] -->
   1975              { volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] }
   1976 
   1977      or
   1978 
   1979           extern type extern_array[];
   1980           extern_array[1] -->
   1981              { volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] }
   1982 
   1983      For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
   1984      is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...)
   1985      variable:
   1986 
   1987           extern struct s extern_struct;
   1988           extern_struct.field -->
   1989              { volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field }
   1990 
   1991      or
   1992 
   1993           extern long long extern_ll;
   1994           extern_ll -->
   1995             { volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll }
   1996 
   1997      A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
   1998      'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
   1999      `__declspec(dllimport)'.  However, in practice that requires using
   2000      compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are building a DLL,
   2001      building client code that will link to the DLL, or merely
   2002      building/linking to a static library.   In making the choice
   2003      between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
   2004      constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world
   2005      usage:
   2006 
   2007      Original:
   2008           --foo.h
   2009           extern int arr[];
   2010           --foo.c
   2011           #include "foo.h"
   2012           void main(int argc, char **argv){
   2013             printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
   2014           }
   2015 
   2016      Solution 1:
   2017           --foo.h
   2018           extern int arr[];
   2019           --foo.c
   2020           #include "foo.h"
   2021           void main(int argc, char **argv){
   2022             /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
   2023             volatile int *parr = arr;
   2024             printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
   2025           }
   2026 
   2027      Solution 2:
   2028           --foo.h
   2029           /* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
   2030           #if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
   2031             !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
   2032           #define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
   2033           #else
   2034           #define FOO_IMPORT
   2035           #endif
   2036           extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
   2037           --foo.c
   2038           #include "foo.h"
   2039           void main(int argc, char **argv){
   2040             printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
   2041           }
   2042 
   2043      A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your library to
   2044      use a functional interface rather than a data interface for the
   2045      offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
   2046      functions).  [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port
   2047      of the linker]
   2048 
   2049 `--disable-auto-import'
   2050      Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of `_symbol' to
   2051      `__imp__symbol' for DATA imports from DLLs.  [This option is
   2052      specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
   2053 
   2054 `--enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc'
   2055      If your code contains expressions described in -enable-auto-import
   2056      section, that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this
   2057      switch will create a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which
   2058      can be used by runtime environment to adjust references to such
   2059      data in your client code.  [This option is specific to the i386 PE
   2060      targeted port of the linker]
   2061 
   2062 `--disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc'
   2063      Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports
   2064      from DLLs.  [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port
   2065      of the linker]
   2066 
   2067 `--enable-extra-pe-debug'
   2068      Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
   2069      [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the
   2070      linker]
   2071 
   2072 `--section-alignment'
   2073      Sets the section alignment.  Sections in memory will always begin
   2074      at addresses which are a multiple of this number.  Defaults to
   2075      0x1000.  [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of
   2076      the linker]
   2077 
   2078 `--stack RESERVE'
   2079 `--stack RESERVE,COMMIT'
   2080      Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally
   2081      commit) to be used as stack for this program.  The default is 2MB
   2082      reserved, 4K committed.  [This option is specific to the i386 PE
   2083      targeted port of the linker]
   2084 
   2085 `--subsystem WHICH'
   2086 `--subsystem WHICH:MAJOR'
   2087 `--subsystem WHICH:MAJOR.MINOR'
   2088      Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute.  The
   2089      legal values for WHICH are `native', `windows', `console',
   2090      `posix', and `xbox'.  You may optionally set the subsystem version
   2091      also.  Numeric values are also accepted for WHICH.  [This option
   2092      is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
   2093 
   2094      The following options set flags in the `DllCharacteristics' field
   2095      of the PE file header: [These options are specific to PE targeted
   2096      ports of the linker]
   2097 
   2098 `--high-entropy-va'
   2099      Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
   2100      (ASLR).
   2101 
   2102 `--dynamicbase'
   2103      The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
   2104      randomization (ASLR).  This feature was introduced with MS Windows
   2105      Vista for i386 PE targets.
   2106 
   2107 `--forceinteg'
   2108      Code integrity checks are enforced.
   2109 
   2110 `--nxcompat'
   2111      The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.  This
   2112      feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE targets.
   2113 
   2114 `--no-isolation'
   2115      Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
   2116 
   2117 `--no-seh'
   2118      The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from this
   2119      image.
   2120 
   2121 `--no-bind'
   2122      Do not bind this image.
   2123 
   2124 `--wdmdriver'
   2125      The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model.
   2126 
   2127 `--tsaware'
   2128      The image is Terminal Server aware.
   2129 
   2130 `--insert-timestamp'
   2131 `--no-insert-timestamp'
   2132      Insert a real timestamp into the image.  This is the default
   2133      behaviour as it matches legacy code and it means that the image
   2134      will work with other, proprietary tools.  The problem with this
   2135      default is that it will result in slightly different images being
   2136      produced each tiem the same sources are linked.  The option
   2137      `--no-insert-timestamp' can be used to insert a zero value for the
   2138      timestamp, this ensuring that binaries produced from indentical
   2139      sources will compare identically.
   2140 
   2141 2.1.2 Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
   2142 ---------------------------------------------
   2143 
   2144 The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support
   2145 shared libraries.  Each shared library in the system needs to have a
   2146 unique index; all executables use an index of 0.
   2147 
   2148 `--dsbt-size SIZE'
   2149      This option sets the number of entires in the DSBT of the current
   2150      executable or shared library to SIZE.  The default is to create a
   2151      table with 64 entries.
   2152 
   2153 `--dsbt-index INDEX'
   2154      This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or
   2155      shared library to INDEX.  The default is 0, which is appropriate
   2156      for generating executables.  If a shared library is generated with
   2157      a DSBT index of 0, the `R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX' relocs are copied into
   2158      the output file.
   2159 
   2160      The `--no-merge-exidx-entries' switch disables the merging of
   2161      adjacent exidx entries in frame unwind info.
   2162 
   2163 
   2164 2.1.3 Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
   2165 ------------------------------------------------------------
   2166 
   2167 The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
   2168 memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
   2169 
   2170 `--no-trampoline'
   2171      This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a
   2172      trampoline is generated for each far function which is called
   2173      using a `jsr' instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far
   2174      function is taken).
   2175 
   2176 `--bank-window NAME'
   2177      This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region
   2178      in the `MEMORY' specification that describes the memory bank
   2179      window.  The definition of such region is then used by the linker
   2180      to compute paging and addresses within the memory window.
   2181 
   2182 
   2183 2.1.4 Options specific to Motorola 68K target
   2184 ---------------------------------------------
   2185 
   2186 The following options are supported to control handling of GOT
   2187 generation when linking for 68K targets.
   2188 
   2189 `--got=TYPE'
   2190      This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
   2191      TYPE should be one of `single', `negative', `multigot' or
   2192      `target'.  For more information refer to the Info entry for `ld'.
   2193 
   2194 
   2195 2.1.5 Options specific to MIPS targets
   2196 --------------------------------------
   2197 
   2198 The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
   2199 generation when linking for MIPS targets.
   2200 
   2201 `--insn32'
   2202 `--no-insn32'
   2203      These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in
   2204      code generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy
   2205      binding stubs, or in relaxation.  If `--insn32' is used, then the
   2206      linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings.  By default or if
   2207      `--no-insn32' is used, all instruction encodings are used,
   2208      including 16-bit ones where possible.
   2209 
   2210 
   2211 
   2212 File: ld.info,  Node: Environment,  Prev: Options,  Up: Invocation
   2213 
   2214 2.2 Environment Variables
   2215 =========================
   2216 
   2217 You can change the behaviour of `ld' with the environment variables
   2218 `GNUTARGET', `LDEMULATION' and `COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE'.
   2219 
   2220    `GNUTARGET' determines the input-file object format if you don't use
   2221 `-b' (or its synonym `--format').  Its value should be one of the BFD
   2222 names for an input format (*note BFD::).  If there is no `GNUTARGET' in
   2223 the environment, `ld' uses the natural format of the target. If
   2224 `GNUTARGET' is set to `default' then BFD attempts to discover the input
   2225 format by examining binary input files; this method often succeeds, but
   2226 there are potential ambiguities, since there is no method of ensuring
   2227 that the magic number used to specify object-file formats is unique.
   2228 However, the configuration procedure for BFD on each system places the
   2229 conventional format for that system first in the search-list, so
   2230 ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
   2231 
   2232    `LDEMULATION' determines the default emulation if you don't use the
   2233 `-m' option.  The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
   2234 behaviour, particularly the default linker script.  You can list the
   2235 available emulations with the `--verbose' or `-V' options.  If the `-m'
   2236 option is not used, and the `LDEMULATION' environment variable is not
   2237 defined, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
   2238 configured.
   2239 
   2240    Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols.  However, if
   2241 `COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE' is set in the environment, then it will default
   2242 to not demangling symbols.  This environment variable is used in a
   2243 similar fashion by the `gcc' linker wrapper program.  The default may
   2244 be overridden by the `--demangle' and `--no-demangle' options.
   2245 
   2246 
   2247 File: ld.info,  Node: Scripts,  Next: Machine Dependent,  Prev: Invocation,  Up: Top
   2248 
   2249 3 Linker Scripts
   2250 ****************
   2251 
   2252 Every link is controlled by a "linker script".  This script is written
   2253 in the linker command language.
   2254 
   2255    The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the
   2256 sections in the input files should be mapped into the output file, and
   2257 to control the memory layout of the output file.  Most linker scripts
   2258 do nothing more than this.  However, when necessary, the linker script
   2259 can also direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the
   2260 commands described below.
   2261 
   2262    The linker always uses a linker script.  If you do not supply one
   2263 yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
   2264 linker executable.  You can use the `--verbose' command line option to
   2265 display the default linker script.  Certain command line options, such
   2266 as `-r' or `-N', will affect the default linker script.
   2267 
   2268    You may supply your own linker script by using the `-T' command line
   2269 option.  When you do this, your linker script will replace the default
   2270 linker script.
   2271 
   2272    You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input
   2273 files to the linker, as though they were files to be linked.  *Note
   2274 Implicit Linker Scripts::.
   2275 
   2276 * Menu:
   2277 
   2278 * Basic Script Concepts::	Basic Linker Script Concepts
   2279 * Script Format::		Linker Script Format
   2280 * Simple Example::		Simple Linker Script Example
   2281 * Simple Commands::		Simple Linker Script Commands
   2282 * Assignments::			Assigning Values to Symbols
   2283 * SECTIONS::			SECTIONS Command
   2284 * MEMORY::			MEMORY Command
   2285 * PHDRS::			PHDRS Command
   2286 * VERSION::			VERSION Command
   2287 * Expressions::			Expressions in Linker Scripts
   2288 * Implicit Linker Scripts::	Implicit Linker Scripts
   2289 
   2290 
   2291 File: ld.info,  Node: Basic Script Concepts,  Next: Script Format,  Up: Scripts
   2292 
   2293 3.1 Basic Linker Script Concepts
   2294 ================================
   2295 
   2296 We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
   2297 describe the linker script language.
   2298 
   2299    The linker combines input files into a single output file.  The
   2300 output file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
   2301 "object file format".  Each file is called an "object file".  The
   2302 output file is often called an "executable", but for our purposes we
   2303 will also call it an object file.  Each object file has, among other
   2304 things, a list of "sections".  We sometimes refer to a section in an
   2305 input file as an "input section"; similarly, a section in the output
   2306 file is an "output section".
   2307 
   2308    Each section in an object file has a name and a size.  Most sections
   2309 also have an associated block of data, known as the "section contents".
   2310 A section may be marked as "loadable", which means that the contents
   2311 should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.  A section
   2312 with no contents may be "allocatable", which means that an area in
   2313 memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be loaded
   2314 there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out).  A section which
   2315 is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort of
   2316 debugging information.
   2317 
   2318    Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses.  The
   2319 first is the "VMA", or virtual memory address.  This is the address the
   2320 section will have when the output file is run.  The second is the
   2321 "LMA", or load memory address.  This is the address at which the
   2322 section will be loaded.  In most cases the two addresses will be the
   2323 same.  An example of when they might be different is when a data section
   2324 is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
   2325 (this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
   2326 based system).  In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
   2327 RAM address would be the VMA.
   2328 
   2329    You can see the sections in an object file by using the `objdump'
   2330 program with the `-h' option.
   2331 
   2332    Every object file also has a list of "symbols", known as the "symbol
   2333 table".  A symbol may be defined or undefined.  Each symbol has a name,
   2334 and each defined symbol has an address, among other information.  If
   2335 you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you will get a
   2336 defined symbol for every defined function and global or static
   2337 variable.  Every undefined function or global variable which is
   2338 referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
   2339 
   2340    You can see the symbols in an object file by using the `nm' program,
   2341 or by using the `objdump' program with the `-t' option.
   2342 
   2343 
   2344 File: ld.info,  Node: Script Format,  Next: Simple Example,  Prev: Basic Script Concepts,  Up: Scripts
   2345 
   2346 3.2 Linker Script Format
   2347 ========================
   2348 
   2349 Linker scripts are text files.
   2350 
   2351    You write a linker script as a series of commands.  Each command is
   2352 either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
   2353 symbol.  You may separate commands using semicolons.  Whitespace is
   2354 generally ignored.
   2355 
   2356    Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered
   2357 directly.  If the file name contains a character such as a comma which
   2358 would otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name
   2359 in double quotes.  There is no way to use a double quote character in a
   2360 file name.
   2361 
   2362    You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
   2363 `/*' and `*/'.  As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent to
   2364 whitespace.
   2365 
   2366 
   2367 File: ld.info,  Node: Simple Example,  Next: Simple Commands,  Prev: Script Format,  Up: Scripts
   2368 
   2369 3.3 Simple Linker Script Example
   2370 ================================
   2371 
   2372 Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
   2373 
   2374    The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
   2375 `SECTIONS'.  You use the `SECTIONS' command to describe the memory
   2376 layout of the output file.
   2377 
   2378    The `SECTIONS' command is a powerful command.  Here we will describe
   2379 a simple use of it.  Let's assume your program consists only of code,
   2380 initialized data, and uninitialized data.  These will be in the
   2381 `.text', `.data', and `.bss' sections, respectively.  Let's assume
   2382 further that these are the only sections which appear in your input
   2383 files.
   2384 
   2385    For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
   2386 0x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000.  Here is a
   2387 linker script which will do that:
   2388      SECTIONS
   2389      {
   2390        . = 0x10000;
   2391        .text : { *(.text) }
   2392        . = 0x8000000;
   2393        .data : { *(.data) }
   2394        .bss : { *(.bss) }
   2395      }
   2396 
   2397    You write the `SECTIONS' command as the keyword `SECTIONS', followed
   2398 by a series of symbol assignments and output section descriptions
   2399 enclosed in curly braces.
   2400 
   2401    The first line inside the `SECTIONS' command of the above example
   2402 sets the value of the special symbol `.', which is the location
   2403 counter.  If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
   2404 other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
   2405 current value of the location counter.  The location counter is then
   2406 incremented by the size of the output section.  At the start of the
   2407 `SECTIONS' command, the location counter has the value `0'.
   2408 
   2409    The second line defines an output section, `.text'.  The colon is
   2410 required syntax which may be ignored for now.  Within the curly braces
   2411 after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
   2412 which should be placed into this output section.  The `*' is a wildcard
   2413 which matches any file name.  The expression `*(.text)' means all
   2414 `.text' input sections in all input files.
   2415 
   2416    Since the location counter is `0x10000' when the output section
   2417 `.text' is defined, the linker will set the address of the `.text'
   2418 section in the output file to be `0x10000'.
   2419 
   2420    The remaining lines define the `.data' and `.bss' sections in the
   2421 output file.  The linker will place the `.data' output section at
   2422 address `0x8000000'.  After the linker places the `.data' output
   2423 section, the value of the location counter will be `0x8000000' plus the
   2424 size of the `.data' output section.  The effect is that the linker will
   2425 place the `.bss' output section immediately after the `.data' output
   2426 section in memory.
   2427 
   2428    The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
   2429 alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary.  In this
   2430 example, the specified addresses for the `.text' and `.data' sections
   2431 will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker may
   2432 have to create a small gap between the `.data' and `.bss' sections.
   2433 
   2434    That's it!  That's a simple and complete linker script.
   2435 
   2436 
   2437 File: ld.info,  Node: Simple Commands,  Next: Assignments,  Prev: Simple Example,  Up: Scripts
   2438 
   2439 3.4 Simple Linker Script Commands
   2440 =================================
   2441 
   2442 In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
   2443 
   2444 * Menu:
   2445 
   2446 * Entry Point::			Setting the entry point
   2447 * File Commands::		Commands dealing with files
   2448 
   2449 * Format Commands::		Commands dealing with object file formats
   2450 
   2451 * REGION_ALIAS::		Assign alias names to memory regions
   2452 * Miscellaneous Commands::	Other linker script commands
   2453 
   2454 
   2455 File: ld.info,  Node: Entry Point,  Next: File Commands,  Up: Simple Commands
   2456 
   2457 3.4.1 Setting the Entry Point
   2458 -----------------------------
   2459 
   2460 The first instruction to execute in a program is called the "entry
   2461 point".  You can use the `ENTRY' linker script command to set the entry
   2462 point.  The argument is a symbol name:
   2463      ENTRY(SYMBOL)
   2464 
   2465    There are several ways to set the entry point.  The linker will set
   2466 the entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
   2467 stopping when one of them succeeds:
   2468    * the `-e' ENTRY command-line option;
   2469 
   2470    * the `ENTRY(SYMBOL)' command in a linker script;
   2471 
   2472    * the value of a target specific symbol, if it is defined;  For many
   2473      targets this is `start', but PE and BeOS based systems for example
   2474      check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one
   2475      found.
   2476 
   2477    * the address of the first byte of the `.text' section, if present;
   2478 
   2479    * The address `0'.
   2480 
   2481 
   2482 File: ld.info,  Node: File Commands,  Next: Format Commands,  Prev: Entry Point,  Up: Simple Commands
   2483 
   2484 3.4.2 Commands Dealing with Files
   2485 ---------------------------------
   2486 
   2487 Several linker script commands deal with files.
   2488 
   2489 `INCLUDE FILENAME'
   2490      Include the linker script FILENAME at this point.  The file will
   2491      be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory
   2492      specified with the `-L' option.  You can nest calls to `INCLUDE'
   2493      up to 10 levels deep.
   2494 
   2495      You can place `INCLUDE' directives at the top level, in `MEMORY' or
   2496      `SECTIONS' commands, or in output section descriptions.
   2497 
   2498 `INPUT(FILE, FILE, ...)'
   2499 `INPUT(FILE FILE ...)'
   2500      The `INPUT' command directs the linker to include the named files
   2501      in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
   2502 
   2503      For example, if you always want to include `subr.o' any time you do
   2504      a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command
   2505      line, then you can put `INPUT (subr.o)' in your linker script.
   2506 
   2507      In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the
   2508      linker script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a `-T'
   2509      option.
   2510 
   2511      In case a "sysroot prefix" is configured, and the filename starts
   2512      with the `/' character, and the script being processed was located
   2513      inside the "sysroot prefix", the filename will be looked for in
   2514      the "sysroot prefix".  Otherwise, the linker will try to open the
   2515      file in the current directory.  If it is not found, the linker
   2516      will search through the archive library search path.  The "sysroot
   2517      prefix" can also be forced by specifying `=' as the first
   2518      character in the filename path.  See also the description of `-L'
   2519      in *Note Command Line Options: Options.
   2520 
   2521      If you use `INPUT (-lFILE)', `ld' will transform the name to
   2522      `libFILE.a', as with the command line argument `-l'.
   2523 
   2524      When you use the `INPUT' command in an implicit linker script, the
   2525      files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
   2526      script file is included.  This can affect archive searching.
   2527 
   2528 `GROUP(FILE, FILE, ...)'
   2529 `GROUP(FILE FILE ...)'
   2530      The `GROUP' command is like `INPUT', except that the named files
   2531      should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
   2532      new undefined references are created.  See the description of `-('
   2533      in *Note Command Line Options: Options.
   2534 
   2535 `AS_NEEDED(FILE, FILE, ...)'
   2536 `AS_NEEDED(FILE FILE ...)'
   2537      This construct can appear only inside of the `INPUT' or `GROUP'
   2538      commands, among other filenames.  The files listed will be handled
   2539      as if they appear directly in the `INPUT' or `GROUP' commands,
   2540      with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
   2541      when they are actually needed.  This construct essentially enables
   2542      `--as-needed' option for all the files listed inside of it and
   2543      restores previous `--as-needed' resp. `--no-as-needed' setting
   2544      afterwards.
   2545 
   2546 `OUTPUT(FILENAME)'
   2547      The `OUTPUT' command names the output file.  Using
   2548      `OUTPUT(FILENAME)' in the linker script is exactly like using `-o
   2549      FILENAME' on the command line (*note Command Line Options:
   2550      Options.).  If both are used, the command line option takes
   2551      precedence.
   2552 
   2553      You can use the `OUTPUT' command to define a default name for the
   2554      output file other than the usual default of `a.out'.
   2555 
   2556 `SEARCH_DIR(PATH)'
   2557      The `SEARCH_DIR' command adds PATH to the list of paths where `ld'
   2558      looks for archive libraries.  Using `SEARCH_DIR(PATH)' is exactly
   2559      like using `-L PATH' on the command line (*note Command Line
   2560      Options: Options.).  If both are used, then the linker will search
   2561      both paths.  Paths specified using the command line option are
   2562      searched first.
   2563 
   2564 `STARTUP(FILENAME)'
   2565      The `STARTUP' command is just like the `INPUT' command, except
   2566      that FILENAME will become the first input file to be linked, as
   2567      though it were specified first on the command line.  This may be
   2568      useful when using a system in which the entry point is always the
   2569      start of the first file.
   2570 
   2571 
   2572 File: ld.info,  Node: Format Commands,  Next: REGION_ALIAS,  Prev: File Commands,  Up: Simple Commands
   2573 
   2574 3.4.3 Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
   2575 -----------------------------------------------
   2576 
   2577 A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
   2578 
   2579 `OUTPUT_FORMAT(BFDNAME)'
   2580 `OUTPUT_FORMAT(DEFAULT, BIG, LITTLE)'
   2581      The `OUTPUT_FORMAT' command names the BFD format to use for the
   2582      output file (*note BFD::).  Using `OUTPUT_FORMAT(BFDNAME)' is
   2583      exactly like using `--oformat BFDNAME' on the command line (*note
   2584      Command Line Options: Options.).  If both are used, the command
   2585      line option takes precedence.
   2586 
   2587      You can use `OUTPUT_FORMAT' with three arguments to use different
   2588      formats based on the `-EB' and `-EL' command line options.  This
   2589      permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
   2590      desired endianness.
   2591 
   2592      If neither `-EB' nor `-EL' are used, then the output format will
   2593      be the first argument, DEFAULT.  If `-EB' is used, the output
   2594      format will be the second argument, BIG.  If `-EL' is used, the
   2595      output format will be the third argument, LITTLE.
   2596 
   2597      For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target
   2598      uses this command:
   2599           OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
   2600      This says that the default format for the output file is
   2601      `elf32-bigmips', but if the user uses the `-EL' command line
   2602      option, the output file will be created in the `elf32-littlemips'
   2603      format.
   2604 
   2605 `TARGET(BFDNAME)'
   2606      The `TARGET' command names the BFD format to use when reading input
   2607      files.  It affects subsequent `INPUT' and `GROUP' commands.  This
   2608      command is like using `-b BFDNAME' on the command line (*note
   2609      Command Line Options: Options.).  If the `TARGET' command is used
   2610      but `OUTPUT_FORMAT' is not, then the last `TARGET' command is also
   2611      used to set the format for the output file.  *Note BFD::.
   2612 
   2613 
   2614 File: ld.info,  Node: REGION_ALIAS,  Next: Miscellaneous Commands,  Prev: Format Commands,  Up: Simple Commands
   2615 
   2616 3.4.4 Assign alias names to memory regions
   2617 ------------------------------------------
   2618 
   2619 Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
   2620 *Note MEMORY:: command.  Each name corresponds to at most one memory
   2621 region.
   2622 
   2623      REGION_ALIAS(ALIAS, REGION)
   2624 
   2625    The `REGION_ALIAS' function creates an alias name ALIAS for the
   2626 memory region REGION.  This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
   2627 to memory regions.  An example follows.
   2628 
   2629    Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with
   2630 various memory storage devices.  All have a general purpose, volatile
   2631 memory `RAM' that allows code execution or data storage.  Some may have
   2632 a read-only, non-volatile memory `ROM' that allows code execution and
   2633 read-only data access.  The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile
   2634 memory `ROM2' with read-only data access and no code execution
   2635 capability.  We have four output sections:
   2636 
   2637    * `.text' program code;
   2638 
   2639    * `.rodata' read-only data;
   2640 
   2641    * `.data' read-write initialized data;
   2642 
   2643    * `.bss' read-write zero initialized data.
   2644 
   2645    The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system
   2646 independent part defining the output sections and a system dependent
   2647 part mapping the output sections to the memory regions available on the
   2648 system.  Our embedded systems come with three different memory setups
   2649 `A', `B' and `C':
   2650 Section            Variant A          Variant B          Variant C
   2651 .text              RAM                ROM                ROM
   2652 .rodata            RAM                ROM                ROM2
   2653 .data              RAM                RAM/ROM            RAM/ROM2
   2654 .bss               RAM                RAM                RAM
   2655    The notation `RAM/ROM' or `RAM/ROM2' means that this section is
   2656 loaded into region `ROM' or `ROM2' respectively.  Please note that the
   2657 load address of the `.data' section starts in all three variants at the
   2658 end of the `.rodata' section.
   2659 
   2660    The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows.
   2661 It includes the system dependent `linkcmds.memory' file that describes
   2662 the memory layout:
   2663      INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
   2664 
   2665      SECTIONS
   2666        {
   2667          .text :
   2668            {
   2669              *(.text)
   2670            } > REGION_TEXT
   2671          .rodata :
   2672            {
   2673              *(.rodata)
   2674              rodata_end = .;
   2675            } > REGION_RODATA
   2676          .data : AT (rodata_end)
   2677            {
   2678              data_start = .;
   2679              *(.data)
   2680            } > REGION_DATA
   2681          data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
   2682          data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
   2683          .bss :
   2684            {
   2685              *(.bss)
   2686            } > REGION_BSS
   2687        }
   2688 
   2689    Now we need three different `linkcmds.memory' files to define memory
   2690 regions and alias names.  The content of `linkcmds.memory' for the three
   2691 variants `A', `B' and `C':
   2692 `A'
   2693      Here everything goes into the `RAM'.
   2694           MEMORY
   2695             {
   2696               RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
   2697             }
   2698 
   2699           REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
   2700           REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
   2701           REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
   2702           REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
   2703 
   2704 `B'
   2705      Program code and read-only data go into the `ROM'.  Read-write
   2706      data goes into the `RAM'.  An image of the initialized data is
   2707      loaded into the `ROM' and will be copied during system start into
   2708      the `RAM'.
   2709           MEMORY
   2710             {
   2711               ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
   2712               RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
   2713             }
   2714 
   2715           REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
   2716           REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
   2717           REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
   2718           REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
   2719 
   2720 `C'
   2721      Program code goes into the `ROM'.  Read-only data goes into the
   2722      `ROM2'.  Read-write data goes into the `RAM'.  An image of the
   2723      initialized data is loaded into the `ROM2' and will be copied
   2724      during system start into the `RAM'.
   2725           MEMORY
   2726             {
   2727               ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
   2728               ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
   2729               RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
   2730             }
   2731 
   2732           REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
   2733           REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
   2734           REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
   2735           REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
   2736 
   2737    It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to
   2738 copy the `.data' section from `ROM' or `ROM2' into the `RAM' if
   2739 necessary:
   2740      #include <string.h>
   2741 
   2742      extern char data_start [];
   2743      extern char data_size [];
   2744      extern char data_load_start [];
   2745 
   2746      void copy_data(void)
   2747      {
   2748        if (data_start != data_load_start)
   2749          {
   2750            memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
   2751          }
   2752      }
   2753 
   2754 
   2755 File: ld.info,  Node: Miscellaneous Commands,  Prev: REGION_ALIAS,  Up: Simple Commands
   2756 
   2757 3.4.5 Other Linker Script Commands
   2758 ----------------------------------
   2759 
   2760 There are a few other linker scripts commands.
   2761 
   2762 `ASSERT(EXP, MESSAGE)'
   2763      Ensure that EXP is non-zero.  If it is zero, then exit the linker
   2764      with an error code, and print MESSAGE.
   2765 
   2766 `EXTERN(SYMBOL SYMBOL ...)'
   2767      Force SYMBOL to be entered in the output file as an undefined
   2768      symbol.  Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
   2769      modules from standard libraries.  You may list several SYMBOLs for
   2770      each `EXTERN', and you may use `EXTERN' multiple times.  This
   2771      command has the same effect as the `-u' command-line option.
   2772 
   2773 `FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION'
   2774      This command has the same effect as the `-d' command-line option:
   2775      to make `ld' assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
   2776      output file is specified (`-r').
   2777 
   2778 `INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION'
   2779      This command has the same effect as the `--no-define-common'
   2780      command-line option: to make `ld' omit the assignment of addresses
   2781      to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
   2782 
   2783 `INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] OUTPUT_SECTION'
   2784      This command is typically used in a script specified by `-T' to
   2785      augment the default `SECTIONS' with, for example, overlays.  It
   2786      inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
   2787      OUTPUT_SECTION, and also causes `-T' to not override the default
   2788      linker script.  The exact insertion point is as for orphan
   2789      sections.  *Note Location Counter::.  The insertion happens after
   2790      the linker has mapped input sections to output sections.  Prior to
   2791      the insertion, since `-T' scripts are parsed before the default
   2792      linker script, statements in the `-T' script occur before the
   2793      default linker script statements in the internal linker
   2794      representation of the script.  In particular, input section
   2795      assignments will be made to `-T' output sections before those in
   2796      the default script.  Here is an example of how a `-T' script using
   2797      `INSERT' might look:
   2798 
   2799           SECTIONS
   2800           {
   2801             OVERLAY :
   2802             {
   2803               .ov1 { ov1*(.text) }
   2804               .ov2 { ov2*(.text) }
   2805             }
   2806           }
   2807           INSERT AFTER .text;
   2808 
   2809 `NOCROSSREFS(SECTION SECTION ...)'
   2810      This command may be used to tell `ld' to issue an error about any
   2811      references among certain output sections.
   2812 
   2813      In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
   2814      using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another
   2815      section will not be.  Any direct references between the two
   2816      sections would be errors.  For example, it would be an error if
   2817      code in one section called a function defined in the other section.
   2818 
   2819      The `NOCROSSREFS' command takes a list of output section names.  If
   2820      `ld' detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
   2821      an error and returns a non-zero exit status.  Note that the
   2822      `NOCROSSREFS' command uses output section names, not input section
   2823      names.
   2824 
   2825 `OUTPUT_ARCH(BFDARCH)'
   2826      Specify a particular output machine architecture.  The argument is
   2827      one of the names used by the BFD library (*note BFD::).  You can
   2828      see the architecture of an object file by using the `objdump'
   2829      program with the `-f' option.
   2830 
   2831 `LD_FEATURE(STRING)'
   2832      This command may be used to modify `ld' behavior.  If STRING is
   2833      `"SANE_EXPR"' then absolute symbols and numbers in a script are
   2834      simply treated as numbers everywhere.  *Note Expression Section::.
   2835 
   2836 
   2837 File: ld.info,  Node: Assignments,  Next: SECTIONS,  Prev: Simple Commands,  Up: Scripts
   2838 
   2839 3.5 Assigning Values to Symbols
   2840 ===============================
   2841 
   2842 You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script.  This will define
   2843 the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
   2844 
   2845 * Menu:
   2846 
   2847 * Simple Assignments::		Simple Assignments
   2848 * HIDDEN::			HIDDEN
   2849 * PROVIDE::			PROVIDE
   2850 * PROVIDE_HIDDEN::		PROVIDE_HIDDEN
   2851 * Source Code Reference::	How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
   2852 
   2853 
   2854 File: ld.info,  Node: Simple Assignments,  Next: HIDDEN,  Up: Assignments
   2855 
   2856 3.5.1 Simple Assignments
   2857 ------------------------
   2858 
   2859 You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
   2860 
   2861 `SYMBOL = EXPRESSION ;'
   2862 `SYMBOL += EXPRESSION ;'
   2863 `SYMBOL -= EXPRESSION ;'
   2864 `SYMBOL *= EXPRESSION ;'
   2865 `SYMBOL /= EXPRESSION ;'
   2866 `SYMBOL <<= EXPRESSION ;'
   2867 `SYMBOL >>= EXPRESSION ;'
   2868 `SYMBOL &= EXPRESSION ;'
   2869 `SYMBOL |= EXPRESSION ;'
   2870 
   2871    The first case will define SYMBOL to the value of EXPRESSION.  In
   2872 the other cases, SYMBOL must already be defined, and the value will be
   2873 adjusted accordingly.
   2874 
   2875    The special symbol name `.' indicates the location counter.  You may
   2876 only use this within a `SECTIONS' command.  *Note Location Counter::.
   2877 
   2878    The semicolon after EXPRESSION is required.
   2879 
   2880    Expressions are defined below; see *Note Expressions::.
   2881 
   2882    You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or
   2883 as statements within a `SECTIONS' command, or as part of an output
   2884 section description in a `SECTIONS' command.
   2885 
   2886    The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
   2887 expression; for more information, see *Note Expression Section::.
   2888 
   2889    Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
   2890 assignments may be used:
   2891 
   2892      floating_point = 0;
   2893      SECTIONS
   2894      {
   2895        .text :
   2896          {
   2897            *(.text)
   2898            _etext = .;
   2899          }
   2900        _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
   2901        .data : { *(.data) }
   2902      }
   2903    In this example, the symbol `floating_point' will be defined as
   2904 zero.  The symbol `_etext' will be defined as the address following the
   2905 last `.text' input section.  The symbol `_bdata' will be defined as the
   2906 address following the `.text' output section aligned upward to a 4 byte
   2907 boundary.
   2908 
   2909 
   2910 File: ld.info,  Node: HIDDEN,  Next: PROVIDE,  Prev: Simple Assignments,  Up: Assignments
   2911 
   2912 3.5.2 HIDDEN
   2913 ------------
   2914 
   2915 For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
   2916 exported.  The syntax is `HIDDEN(SYMBOL = EXPRESSION)'.
   2917 
   2918    Here is the example from *Note Simple Assignments::, rewritten to use
   2919 `HIDDEN':
   2920 
   2921      HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
   2922      SECTIONS
   2923      {
   2924        .text :
   2925          {
   2926            *(.text)
   2927            HIDDEN(_etext = .);
   2928          }
   2929        HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
   2930        .data : { *(.data) }
   2931      }
   2932    In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this
   2933 module.
   2934 
   2935 
   2936 File: ld.info,  Node: PROVIDE,  Next: PROVIDE_HIDDEN,  Prev: HIDDEN,  Up: Assignments
   2937 
   2938 3.5.3 PROVIDE
   2939 -------------
   2940 
   2941 In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
   2942 only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
   2943 the link.  For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol `etext'.
   2944 However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use `etext' as a
   2945 function name without encountering an error.  The `PROVIDE' keyword may
   2946 be used to define a symbol, such as `etext', only if it is referenced
   2947 but not defined.  The syntax is `PROVIDE(SYMBOL = EXPRESSION)'.
   2948 
   2949    Here is an example of using `PROVIDE' to define `etext':
   2950      SECTIONS
   2951      {
   2952        .text :
   2953          {
   2954            *(.text)
   2955            _etext = .;
   2956            PROVIDE(etext = .);
   2957          }
   2958      }
   2959 
   2960    In this example, if the program defines `_etext' (with a leading
   2961 underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition error.  If, on
   2962 the other hand, the program defines `etext' (with no leading
   2963 underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
   2964 If the program references `etext' but does not define it, the linker
   2965 will use the definition in the linker script.
   2966 
   2967 
   2968 File: ld.info,  Node: PROVIDE_HIDDEN,  Next: Source Code Reference,  Prev: PROVIDE,  Up: Assignments
   2969 
   2970 3.5.4 PROVIDE_HIDDEN
   2971 --------------------
   2972 
   2973 Similar to `PROVIDE'.  For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
   2974 hidden and won't be exported.
   2975 
   2976 
   2977 File: ld.info,  Node: Source Code Reference,  Prev: PROVIDE_HIDDEN,  Up: Assignments
   2978 
   2979 3.5.5 Source Code Reference
   2980 ---------------------------
   2981 
   2982 Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
   2983 intuitive.  In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to a
   2984 variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a symbol
   2985 that does not have a value.
   2986 
   2987    Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
   2988 transform names in the source code into different names when they are
   2989 stored in the symbol table.  For example, Fortran compilers commonly
   2990 prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive `name
   2991 mangling'.  Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name of
   2992 a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
   2993 variable as it is defined in a linker script.  For example in C a
   2994 linker script variable might be referred to as:
   2995 
   2996        extern int foo;
   2997 
   2998    But in the linker script it might be defined as:
   2999 
   3000        _foo = 1000;
   3001 
   3002    In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
   3003 transformation has taken place.
   3004 
   3005    When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
   3006 things happen.  The first is that the compiler reserves enough space in
   3007 the program's memory to hold the _value_ of the symbol.  The second is
   3008 that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol table which
   3009 holds the symbol's _address_.  ie the symbol table contains the address
   3010 of the block of memory holding the symbol's value.  So for example the
   3011 following C declaration, at file scope:
   3012 
   3013        int foo = 1000;
   3014 
   3015    creates an entry called `foo' in the symbol table.  This entry holds
   3016 the address of an `int' sized block of memory where the number 1000 is
   3017 initially stored.
   3018 
   3019    When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
   3020 first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
   3021 memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
   3022 So:
   3023 
   3024        foo = 1;
   3025 
   3026    looks up the symbol `foo' in the symbol table, gets the address
   3027 associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
   3028 address.  Whereas:
   3029 
   3030        int * a = & foo;
   3031 
   3032    looks up the symbol `foo' in the symbol table, gets its address and
   3033 then copies this address into the block of memory associated with the
   3034 variable `a'.
   3035 
   3036    Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
   3037 the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them.  Thus they are
   3038 an address without a value.  So for example the linker script
   3039 definition:
   3040 
   3041        foo = 1000;
   3042 
   3043    creates an entry in the symbol table called `foo' which holds the
   3044 address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
   3045 address 1000.  This means that you cannot access the _value_ of a
   3046 linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
   3047 access the _address_ of a linker script defined symbol.
   3048 
   3049    Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source
   3050 code you should always take the address of the symbol, and never
   3051 attempt to use its value.  For example suppose you want to copy the
   3052 contents of a section of memory called .ROM into a section called
   3053 .FLASH and the linker script contains these declarations:
   3054 
   3055        start_of_ROM   = .ROM;
   3056        end_of_ROM     = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM) - 1;
   3057        start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
   3058 
   3059    Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
   3060 
   3061        extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
   3062 
   3063        memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
   3064 
   3065    Note the use of the `&' operators.  These are correct.
   3066 
   3067 
   3068 File: ld.info,  Node: SECTIONS,  Next: MEMORY,  Prev: Assignments,  Up: Scripts
   3069 
   3070 3.6 SECTIONS Command
   3071 ====================
   3072 
   3073 The `SECTIONS' command tells the linker how to map input sections into
   3074 output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
   3075 
   3076    The format of the `SECTIONS' command is:
   3077      SECTIONS
   3078      {
   3079        SECTIONS-COMMAND
   3080        SECTIONS-COMMAND
   3081        ...
   3082      }
   3083 
   3084    Each SECTIONS-COMMAND may of be one of the following:
   3085 
   3086    * an `ENTRY' command (*note Entry command: Entry Point.)
   3087 
   3088    * a symbol assignment (*note Assignments::)
   3089 
   3090    * an output section description
   3091 
   3092    * an overlay description
   3093 
   3094    The `ENTRY' command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
   3095 `SECTIONS' command for convenience in using the location counter in
   3096 those commands.  This can also make the linker script easier to
   3097 understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
   3098 the layout of the output file.
   3099 
   3100    Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
   3101 below.
   3102 
   3103    If you do not use a `SECTIONS' command in your linker script, the
   3104 linker will place each input section into an identically named output
   3105 section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
   3106 input files.  If all input sections are present in the first file, for
   3107 example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
   3108 in the first input file.  The first section will be at address zero.
   3109 
   3110 * Menu:
   3111 
   3112 * Output Section Description::	Output section description
   3113 * Output Section Name::		Output section name
   3114 * Output Section Address::	Output section address
   3115 * Input Section::		Input section description
   3116 * Output Section Data::		Output section data
   3117 * Output Section Keywords::	Output section keywords
   3118 * Output Section Discarding::	Output section discarding
   3119 * Output Section Attributes::	Output section attributes
   3120 * Overlay Description::		Overlay description
   3121 
   3122 
   3123 File: ld.info,  Node: Output Section Description,  Next: Output Section Name,  Up: SECTIONS
   3124 
   3125 3.6.1 Output Section Description
   3126 --------------------------------
   3127 
   3128 The full description of an output section looks like this:
   3129      SECTION [ADDRESS] [(TYPE)] :
   3130        [AT(LMA)]
   3131        [ALIGN(SECTION_ALIGN) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
   3132        [SUBALIGN(SUBSECTION_ALIGN)]
   3133        [CONSTRAINT]
   3134        {
   3135          OUTPUT-SECTION-COMMAND
   3136          OUTPUT-SECTION-COMMAND
   3137          ...
   3138        } [>REGION] [AT>LMA_REGION] [:PHDR :PHDR ...] [=FILLEXP] [,]
   3139 
   3140    Most output sections do not use most of the optional section
   3141 attributes.
   3142 
   3143    The whitespace around SECTION is required, so that the section name
   3144 is unambiguous.  The colon and the curly braces are also required.  The
   3145 comma at the end may be required if a FILLEXP is used and the next
   3146 SECTIONS-COMMAND looks like a continuation of the expression.  The line
   3147 breaks and other white space are optional.
   3148 
   3149    Each OUTPUT-SECTION-COMMAND may be one of the following:
   3150 
   3151    * a symbol assignment (*note Assignments::)
   3152 
   3153    * an input section description (*note Input Section::)
   3154 
   3155    * data values to include directly (*note Output Section Data::)
   3156 
   3157    * a special output section keyword (*note Output Section Keywords::)
   3158 
   3159 
   3160 File: ld.info,  Node: Output Section Name,  Next: Output Section Address,  Prev: Output Section Description,  Up: SECTIONS
   3161 
   3162 3.6.2 Output Section Name
   3163 -------------------------
   3164 
   3165 The name of the output section is SECTION.  SECTION must meet the
   3166 constraints of your output format.  In formats which only support a
   3167 limited number of sections, such as `a.out', the name must be one of
   3168 the names supported by the format (`a.out', for example, allows only
   3169 `.text', `.data' or `.bss'). If the output format supports any number
   3170 of sections, but with numbers and not names (as is the case for Oasys),
   3171 the name should be supplied as a quoted numeric string.  A section name
   3172 may consist of any sequence of characters, but a name which contains
   3173 any unusual characters such as commas must be quoted.
   3174 
   3175    The output section name `/DISCARD/' is special; *Note Output Section
   3176 Discarding::.
   3177 
   3178 
   3179 File: ld.info,  Node: Output Section Address,  Next: Input Section,  Prev: Output Section Name,  Up: SECTIONS
   3180 
   3181 3.6.3 Output Section Address
   3182 ----------------------------
   3183 
   3184 The ADDRESS is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory address)
   3185 of the output section.  This address is optional, but if it is provided
   3186 then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
   3187 
   3188    If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for
   3189 the section, based on the heuristic below.  This address will be
   3190 adjusted to fit the alignment requirement of the output section.  The
   3191 alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
   3192 contained within the output section.
   3193 
   3194    The output section address heuristic is as follows:
   3195 
   3196    * If an output memory REGION is set for the section then it is added
   3197      to this region and its address will be the next free address in
   3198      that region.
   3199 
   3200    * If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
   3201      regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with
   3202      the section is selected to contain it.  The section's output
   3203      address will be the next free address in that region; *Note
   3204      MEMORY::.
   3205 
   3206    * If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
   3207      the output address will be based on the current value of the
   3208      location counter.
   3209 
   3210 For example:
   3211 
   3212      .text . : { *(.text) }
   3213 
   3214 and
   3215 
   3216      .text : { *(.text) }
   3217 
   3218 are subtly different.  The first will set the address of the `.text'
   3219 output section to the current value of the location counter.  The
   3220 second will set it to the current value of the location counter aligned
   3221 to the strictest alignment of any of the `.text' input sections.
   3222 
   3223    The ADDRESS may be an arbitrary expression; *Note Expressions::.
   3224 For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
   3225 so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
   3226 do something like this:
   3227      .text ALIGN(0x10) : { *(.text) }
   3228    This works because `ALIGN' returns the current location counter
   3229 aligned upward to the specified value.
   3230 
   3231    Specifying ADDRESS for a section will change the value of the
   3232 location counter, provided that the section is non-empty.  (Empty
   3233 sections are ignored).
   3234 
   3235 
   3236 File: ld.info,  Node: Input Section,  Next: Output Section Data,  Prev: Output Section Address,  Up: SECTIONS
   3237 
   3238 3.6.4 Input Section Description
   3239 -------------------------------
   3240 
   3241 The most common output section command is an input section description.
   3242 
   3243    The input section description is the most basic linker script
   3244 operation.  You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out
   3245 your program in memory.  You use input section descriptions to tell the
   3246 linker how to map the input files into your memory layout.
   3247 
   3248 * Menu:
   3249 
   3250 * Input Section Basics::	Input section basics
   3251 * Input Section Wildcards::	Input section wildcard patterns
   3252 * Input Section Common::	Input section for common symbols
   3253 * Input Section Keep::		Input section and garbage collection
   3254 * Input Section Example::	Input section example
   3255 
   3256 
   3257 File: ld.info,  Node: Input Section Basics,  Next: Input Section Wildcards,  Up: Input Section
   3258 
   3259 3.6.4.1 Input Section Basics
   3260 ............................
   3261 
   3262 An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
   3263 by a list of section names in parentheses.
   3264 
   3265    The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
   3266 describe further below (*note Input Section Wildcards::).
   3267 
   3268    The most common input section description is to include all input
   3269 sections with a particular name in the output section.  For example, to
   3270 include all input `.text' sections, you would write:
   3271      *(.text)
   3272    Here the `*' is a wildcard which matches any file name.  To exclude
   3273 a list of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may
   3274 be used to match all files except the ones specified in the
   3275 EXCLUDE_FILE list.  For example:
   3276      *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
   3277    will cause all .ctors sections from all files except `crtend.o' and
   3278 `otherfile.o' to be included.
   3279 
   3280    There are two ways to include more than one section:
   3281      *(.text .rdata)
   3282      *(.text) *(.rdata)
   3283    The difference between these is the order in which the `.text' and
   3284 `.rdata' input sections will appear in the output section.  In the
   3285 first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
   3286 they are found in the linker input.  In the second example, all `.text'
   3287 input sections will appear first, followed by all `.rdata' input
   3288 sections.
   3289 
   3290    You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular
   3291 file.  You would do this if one or more of your files contain special
   3292 data that needs to be at a particular location in memory.  For example:
   3293      data.o(.data)
   3294 
   3295    To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
   3296 of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
   3297 
   3298    Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF
   3299 sections:
   3300 
   3301      SECTIONS {
   3302        .text : { INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) }
   3303        .text2 :  { INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) }
   3304      }
   3305 
   3306    In this example, the output section `.text' will be comprised of any
   3307 input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
   3308 `SHF_MERGE' and `SHF_STRINGS' are set.  The output section `.text2'
   3309 will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text) whose
   3310 section header flag `SHF_WRITE' is clear.
   3311 
   3312    You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
   3313 matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file, with
   3314 no whitespace around the colon.
   3315 
   3316 `archive:file'
   3317      matches file within archive
   3318 
   3319 `archive:'
   3320      matches the whole archive
   3321 
   3322 `:file'
   3323      matches file but not one in an archive
   3324 
   3325    Either one or both of `archive' and `file' can contain shell
   3326 wildcards.  On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
   3327 single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so `c:myfile.o'
   3328 is a simple file specification, not `myfile.o' within an archive called
   3329 `c'.  `archive:file' filespecs may also be used within an
   3330 `EXCLUDE_FILE' list, but may not appear in other linker script
   3331 contexts.  For instance, you cannot extract a file from an archive by
   3332 using `archive:file' in an `INPUT' command.
   3333 
   3334    If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections
   3335 in the input file will be included in the output section.  This is not
   3336 commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion.  For example:
   3337      data.o
   3338 
   3339    When you use a file name which is not an `archive:file' specifier
   3340 and does not contain any wild card characters, the linker will first
   3341 see if you also specified the file name on the linker command line or
   3342 in an `INPUT' command.  If you did not, the linker will attempt to open
   3343 the file as an input file, as though it appeared on the command line.
   3344 Note that this differs from an `INPUT' command, because the linker will
   3345 not search for the file in the archive search path.
   3346 
   3347 
   3348 File: ld.info,  Node: Input Section Wildcards,  Next: Input Section Common,  Prev: Input Section Basics,  Up: Input Section
   3349 
   3350 3.6.4.2 Input Section Wildcard Patterns
   3351 .......................................
   3352 
   3353 In an input section description, either the file name or the section
   3354 name or both may be wildcard patterns.
   3355 
   3356    The file name of `*' seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
   3357 pattern for the file name.
   3358 
   3359    The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
   3360 
   3361 `*'
   3362      matches any number of characters
   3363 
   3364 `?'
   3365      matches any single character
   3366 
   3367 `[CHARS]'
   3368      matches a single instance of any of the CHARS; the `-' character
   3369      may be used to specify a range of characters, as in `[a-z]' to
   3370      match any lower case letter
   3371 
   3372 `\'
   3373      quotes the following character
   3374 
   3375    When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
   3376 will not match a `/' character (used to separate directory names on
   3377 Unix).  A pattern consisting of a single `*' character is an exception;
   3378 it will always match any file name, whether it contains a `/' or not.
   3379 In a section name, the wildcard characters will match a `/' character.
   3380 
   3381    File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
   3382 specified on the command line or in an `INPUT' command.  The linker
   3383 does not search directories to expand wildcards.
   3384 
   3385    If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file
   3386 name appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the
   3387 linker will use the first match in the linker script.  For example, this
   3388 sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
   3389 `data.o' rule will not be used:
   3390      .data : { *(.data) }
   3391      .data1 : { data.o(.data) }
   3392 
   3393    Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by
   3394 wildcards in the order in which they are seen during the link.  You can
   3395 change this by using the `SORT_BY_NAME' keyword, which appears before a
   3396 wildcard pattern in parentheses (e.g., `SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)').  When
   3397 the `SORT_BY_NAME' keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or
   3398 sections into ascending order by name before placing them in the output
   3399 file.
   3400 
   3401    `SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT' is very similar to `SORT_BY_NAME'. The
   3402 difference is `SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT' will sort sections into descending
   3403 order by alignment before placing them in the output file.  Larger
   3404 alignments are placed before smaller alignments in order to reduce the
   3405 amount of padding necessary.
   3406 
   3407    `SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY' is very similar to `SORT_BY_NAME'. The
   3408 difference is `SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY' will sort sections into ascending
   3409 order by numerical value of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in
   3410 the section name before placing them in the output file.
   3411 
   3412    `SORT' is an alias for `SORT_BY_NAME'.
   3413 
   3414    When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script,
   3415 there can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
   3416 
   3417   1. `SORT_BY_NAME' (`SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT' (wildcard section pattern)).
   3418      It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment
   3419      if two sections have the same name.
   3420 
   3421   2. `SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT' (`SORT_BY_NAME' (wildcard section pattern)).
   3422      It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name
   3423      if two sections have the same alignment.
   3424 
   3425   3. `SORT_BY_NAME' (`SORT_BY_NAME' (wildcard section pattern)) is
   3426      treated the same as `SORT_BY_NAME' (wildcard section pattern).
   3427 
   3428   4. `SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT' (`SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT' (wildcard section
   3429      pattern)) is treated the same as `SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT' (wildcard
   3430      section pattern).
   3431 
   3432   5. All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
   3433 
   3434    When both command line section sorting option and linker script
   3435 section sorting command are used, section sorting command always takes
   3436 precedence over the command line option.
   3437 
   3438    If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
   3439 command line option will make the section sorting command to be treated
   3440 as nested sorting command.
   3441 
   3442   1. `SORT_BY_NAME' (wildcard section pattern ) with `--sort-sections
   3443      alignment' is equivalent to `SORT_BY_NAME' (`SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT'
   3444      (wildcard section pattern)).
   3445 
   3446   2. `SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT' (wildcard section pattern) with
   3447      `--sort-section name' is equivalent to `SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT'
   3448      (`SORT_BY_NAME' (wildcard section pattern)).
   3449 
   3450    If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
   3451 command line option will be ignored.
   3452 
   3453    `SORT_NONE' disables section sorting by ignoring the command line
   3454 section sorting option.
   3455 
   3456    If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use
   3457 the `-M' linker option to generate a map file.  The map file shows
   3458 precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
   3459 
   3460    This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
   3461 files.  This linker script directs the linker to place all `.text'
   3462 sections in `.text' and all `.bss' sections in `.bss'.  The linker will
   3463 place the `.data' section from all files beginning with an upper case
   3464 character in `.DATA'; for all other files, the linker will place the
   3465 `.data' section in `.data'.
   3466      SECTIONS {
   3467        .text : { *(.text) }
   3468        .DATA : { [A-Z]*(.data) }
   3469        .data : { *(.data) }
   3470        .bss : { *(.bss) }
   3471      }
   3472 
   3473 
   3474 File: ld.info,  Node: Input Section Common,  Next: Input Section Keep,  Prev: Input Section Wildcards,  Up: Input Section
   3475 
   3476 3.6.4.3 Input Section for Common Symbols
   3477 ........................................
   3478 
   3479 A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
   3480 file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section.  The
   3481 linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
   3482 named `COMMON'.
   3483 
   3484    You may use file names with the `COMMON' section just as with any
   3485 other input sections.  You can use this to place common symbols from a
   3486 particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
   3487 input files are placed in another section.
   3488 
   3489    In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
   3490 `.bss' section in the output file.  For example:
   3491      .bss { *(.bss) *(COMMON) }
   3492 
   3493    Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol.
   3494 For example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard
   3495 common symbols and small common symbols.  In this case, the linker will
   3496 use a different special section name for other types of common symbols.
   3497 In the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses `COMMON' for standard common
   3498 symbols and `.scommon' for small common symbols.  This permits you to
   3499 map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
   3500 locations.
   3501 
   3502    You will sometimes see `[COMMON]' in old linker scripts.  This
   3503 notation is now considered obsolete.  It is equivalent to `*(COMMON)'.
   3504 
   3505 
   3506 File: ld.info,  Node: Input Section Keep,  Next: Input Section Example,  Prev: Input Section Common,  Up: Input Section
   3507 
   3508 3.6.4.4 Input Section and Garbage Collection
   3509 ............................................
   3510 
   3511 When link-time garbage collection is in use (`--gc-sections'), it is
   3512 often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.  This is
   3513 accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry with
   3514 `KEEP()', as in `KEEP(*(.init))' or `KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))'.
   3515 
   3516 
   3517 File: ld.info,  Node: Input Section Example,  Prev: Input Section Keep,  Up: Input Section
   3518 
   3519 3.6.4.5 Input Section Example
   3520 .............................
   3521 
   3522 The following example is a complete linker script.  It tells the linker
   3523 to read all of the sections from file `all.o' and place them at the
   3524 start of output section `outputa' which starts at location `0x10000'.
   3525 All of section `.input1' from file `foo.o' follows immediately, in the
   3526 same output section.  All of section `.input2' from `foo.o' goes into
   3527 output section `outputb', followed by section `.input1' from `foo1.o'.
   3528 All of the remaining `.input1' and `.input2' sections from any files
   3529 are written to output section `outputc'.
   3530 
   3531      SECTIONS {
   3532        outputa 0x10000 :
   3533          {
   3534          all.o
   3535          foo.o (.input1)
   3536          }
   3537        outputb :
   3538          {
   3539          foo.o (.input2)
   3540          foo1.o (.input1)
   3541          }
   3542        outputc :
   3543          {
   3544          *(.input1)
   3545          *(.input2)
   3546          }
   3547      }
   3548 
   3549 
   3550 File: ld.info,  Node: Output Section Data,  Next: Output Section Keywords,  Prev: Input Section,  Up: SECTIONS
   3551 
   3552 3.6.5 Output Section Data
   3553 -------------------------
   3554 
   3555 You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
   3556 `BYTE', `SHORT', `LONG', `QUAD', or `SQUAD' as an output section
   3557 command.  Each keyword is followed by an expression in parentheses
   3558 providing the value to store (*note Expressions::).  The value of the
   3559 expression is stored at the current value of the location counter.
   3560 
   3561    The `BYTE', `SHORT', `LONG', and `QUAD' commands store one, two,
   3562 four, and eight bytes (respectively).  After storing the bytes, the
   3563 location counter is incremented by the number of bytes stored.
   3564 
   3565    For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte
   3566 value of the symbol `addr':
   3567      BYTE(1)
   3568      LONG(addr)
   3569 
   3570    When using a 64 bit host or target, `QUAD' and `SQUAD' are the same;
   3571 they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value.  When both host and target
   3572 are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits.  In this case `QUAD'
   3573 stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and `SQUAD' stores a 32
   3574 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
   3575 
   3576    If the object file format of the output file has an explicit
   3577 endianness, which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that
   3578 endianness.  When the object file format does not have an explicit
   3579 endianness, as is true of, for example, S-records, the value will be
   3580 stored in the endianness of the first input object file.
   3581 
   3582    Note--these commands only work inside a section description and not
   3583 between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
   3584      SECTIONS { .text : { *(.text) } LONG(1) .data : { *(.data) } }
   3585    whereas this will work:
   3586      SECTIONS { .text : { *(.text) ; LONG(1) } .data : { *(.data) } }
   3587 
   3588    You may use the `FILL' command to set the fill pattern for the
   3589 current section.  It is followed by an expression in parentheses.  Any
   3590 otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
   3591 gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
   3592 with the value of the expression, repeated as necessary.  A `FILL'
   3593 statement covers memory locations after the point at which it occurs in
   3594 the section definition; by including more than one `FILL' statement,
   3595 you can have different fill patterns in different parts of an output
   3596 section.
   3597 
   3598    This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
   3599 value `0x90':
   3600      FILL(0x90909090)
   3601 
   3602    The `FILL' command is similar to the `=FILLEXP' output section
   3603 attribute, but it only affects the part of the section following the
   3604 `FILL' command, rather than the entire section.  If both are used, the
   3605 `FILL' command takes precedence.  *Note Output Section Fill::, for
   3606 details on the fill expression.
   3607 
   3608 
   3609 File: ld.info,  Node: Output Section Keywords,  Next: Output Section Discarding,  Prev: Output Section Data,  Up: SECTIONS
   3610 
   3611 3.6.6 Output Section Keywords
   3612 -----------------------------
   3613 
   3614 There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
   3615 commands.
   3616 
   3617 `CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS'
   3618      The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input
   3619      file.  The name of each symbol will be the name of the
   3620      corresponding input file.  The section of each symbol will be the
   3621      output section in which the `CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS' command
   3622      appears.
   3623 
   3624      This is conventional for the a.out object file format.  It is not
   3625      normally used for any other object file format.
   3626 
   3627 `CONSTRUCTORS'
   3628      When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
   3629      unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
   3630      destructors.  When linking object file formats which do not support
   3631      arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
   3632      automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by
   3633      name.  For these object file formats, the `CONSTRUCTORS' command
   3634      tells the linker to place constructor information in the output
   3635      section where the `CONSTRUCTORS' command appears.  The
   3636      `CONSTRUCTORS' command is ignored for other object file formats.
   3637 
   3638      The symbol `__CTOR_LIST__' marks the start of the global
   3639      constructors, and the symbol `__CTOR_END__' marks the end.
   3640      Similarly, `__DTOR_LIST__' and `__DTOR_END__' mark the start and
   3641      end of the global destructors.  The first word in the list is the
   3642      number of entries, followed by the address of each constructor or
   3643      destructor, followed by a zero word.  The compiler must arrange to
   3644      actually run the code.  For these object file formats GNU C++
   3645      normally calls constructors from a subroutine `__main'; a call to
   3646      `__main' is automatically inserted into the startup code for
   3647      `main'.  GNU C++ normally runs destructors either by using
   3648      `atexit', or directly from the function `exit'.
   3649 
   3650      For object file formats such as `COFF' or `ELF' which support
   3651      arbitrary section names, GNU C++ will normally arrange to put the
   3652      addresses of global constructors and destructors into the `.ctors'
   3653      and `.dtors' sections.  Placing the following sequence into your
   3654      linker script will build the sort of table which the GNU C++
   3655      runtime code expects to see.
   3656 
   3657                 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
   3658                 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
   3659                 *(.ctors)
   3660                 LONG(0)
   3661                 __CTOR_END__ = .;
   3662                 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
   3663                 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
   3664                 *(.dtors)
   3665                 LONG(0)
   3666                 __DTOR_END__ = .;
   3667 
   3668      If you are using the GNU C++ support for initialization priority,
   3669      which provides some control over the order in which global
   3670      constructors are run, you must sort the constructors at link time
   3671      to ensure that they are executed in the correct order.  When using
   3672      the `CONSTRUCTORS' command, use `SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)'
   3673      instead.  When using the `.ctors' and `.dtors' sections, use
   3674      `*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))' and `*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))' instead of
   3675      just `*(.ctors)' and `*(.dtors)'.
   3676 
   3677      Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues
   3678      automatically, and you will not need to concern yourself with
   3679      them.  However, you may need to consider this if you are using C++
   3680      and writing your own linker scripts.
   3681 
   3682 
   3683 
   3684 File: ld.info,  Node: Output Section Discarding,  Next: Output Section Attributes,  Prev: Output Section Keywords,  Up: SECTIONS
   3685 
   3686 3.6.7 Output Section Discarding
   3687 -------------------------------
   3688 
   3689 The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
   3690 This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
   3691 may not be present in any of the input files.  For example:
   3692      .foo : { *(.foo) }
   3693    will only create a `.foo' section in the output file if there is a
   3694 `.foo' section in at least one input file, and if the input sections
   3695 are not all empty.  Other link script directives that allocate space in
   3696 an output section will also create the output section.  So too will
   3697 assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create space, except
   3698 for `. = 0', `. = . + 0', `. = sym', `. = . + sym' and `. = ALIGN (. !=
   3699 0, expr, 1)' when `sym' is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the
   3700 script.  This allows you to force output of an empty section with `. =
   3701 .'.
   3702 
   3703    The linker will ignore address assignments (*note Output Section
   3704 Address::) on discarded output sections, except when the linker script
   3705 defines symbols in the output section.  In that case the linker will
   3706 obey the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
   3707 section is discarded.
   3708 
   3709    The special output section name `/DISCARD/' may be used to discard
   3710 input sections.  Any input sections which are assigned to an output
   3711 section named `/DISCARD/' are not included in the output file.
   3712 
   3713 
   3714 File: ld.info,  Node: Output Section Attributes,  Next: Overlay Description,  Prev: Output Section Discarding,  Up: SECTIONS
   3715 
   3716 3.6.8 Output Section Attributes
   3717 -------------------------------
   3718 
   3719 We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
   3720 like this:
   3721 
   3722      SECTION [ADDRESS] [(TYPE)] :
   3723        [AT(LMA)]
   3724        [ALIGN(SECTION_ALIGN)]
   3725        [SUBALIGN(SUBSECTION_ALIGN)]
   3726        [CONSTRAINT]
   3727        {
   3728          OUTPUT-SECTION-COMMAND
   3729          OUTPUT-SECTION-COMMAND
   3730          ...
   3731        } [>REGION] [AT>LMA_REGION] [:PHDR :PHDR ...] [=FILLEXP]
   3732 
   3733    We've already described SECTION, ADDRESS, and
   3734 OUTPUT-SECTION-COMMAND.  In this section we will describe the remaining
   3735 section attributes.
   3736 
   3737 * Menu:
   3738 
   3739 * Output Section Type::		Output section type
   3740 * Output Section LMA::		Output section LMA
   3741 * Forced Output Alignment::	Forced Output Alignment
   3742 * Forced Input Alignment::	Forced Input Alignment
   3743 * Output Section Constraint::   Output section constraint
   3744 * Output Section Region::	Output section region
   3745 * Output Section Phdr::		Output section phdr
   3746 * Output Section Fill::		Output section fill
   3747 
   3748 
   3749 File: ld.info,  Node: Output Section Type,  Next: Output Section LMA,  Up: Output Section Attributes
   3750 
   3751 3.6.8.1 Output Section Type
   3752 ...........................
   3753 
   3754 Each output section may have a type.  The type is a keyword in
   3755 parentheses.  The following types are defined:
   3756 
   3757 `NOLOAD'
   3758      The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not
   3759      be loaded into memory when the program is run.
   3760 
   3761 `DSECT'
   3762 `COPY'
   3763 `INFO'
   3764 `OVERLAY'
   3765      These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
   3766      rarely used.  They all have the same effect: the section should be
   3767      marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
   3768      section when the program is run.
   3769 
   3770    The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
   3771 the input sections which map into it.  You can override this by using
   3772 the section type.  For example, in the script sample below, the `ROM'
   3773 section is addressed at memory location `0' and does not need to be
   3774 loaded when the program is run.
   3775      SECTIONS {
   3776        ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : { ... }
   3777        ...
   3778      }
   3779 
   3780 
   3781 File: ld.info,  Node: Output Section LMA,  Next: Forced Output Alignment,  Prev: Output Section Type,  Up: Output Section Attributes
   3782 
   3783 3.6.8.2 Output Section LMA
   3784 ..........................
   3785 
   3786 Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
   3787 *Note Basic Script Concepts::.  The virtual address is specified by the
   3788 *note Output Section Address:: described earlier.  The load address is
   3789 specified by the `AT' or `AT>' keywords.  Specifying a load address is
   3790 optional.
   3791 
   3792    The `AT' keyword takes an expression as an argument.  This specifies
   3793 the exact load address of the section.  The `AT>' keyword takes the
   3794 name of a memory region as an argument.  *Note MEMORY::.  The load
   3795 address of the section is set to the next free address in the region,
   3796 aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
   3797 
   3798    If neither `AT' nor `AT>' is specified for an allocatable section,
   3799 the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the load
   3800 address:
   3801 
   3802    * If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
   3803      the LMA address as well.
   3804 
   3805    * If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
   3806 
   3807    * Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible with
   3808      the current section, and this region contains at least one
   3809      section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the VMA and
   3810      LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of the
   3811      last section in the located region.
   3812 
   3813    * If no memory regions have been declared then a default region that
   3814      covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
   3815 
   3816    * If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
   3817      section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
   3818 
   3819    This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image.  For
   3820 example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
   3821 called `.text', which starts at `0x1000', one called `.mdata', which is
   3822 loaded at the end of the `.text' section even though its VMA is
   3823 `0x2000', and one called `.bss' to hold uninitialized data at address
   3824 `0x3000'.  The symbol `_data' is defined with the value `0x2000', which
   3825 shows that the location counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
   3826 
   3827      SECTIONS
   3828        {
   3829        .text 0x1000 : { *(.text) _etext = . ; }
   3830        .mdata 0x2000 :
   3831          AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
   3832          { _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ;  }
   3833        .bss 0x3000 :
   3834          { _bstart = . ;  *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;}
   3835      }
   3836 
   3837    The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated
   3838 with this linker script would include something like the following, to
   3839 copy the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address.
   3840 Notice how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the
   3841 linker script.
   3842 
   3843      extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
   3844      char *src = &_etext;
   3845      char *dst = &_data;
   3846 
   3847      /* ROM has data at end of text; copy it.  */
   3848      while (dst < &_edata)
   3849        *dst++ = *src++;
   3850 
   3851      /* Zero bss.  */
   3852      for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
   3853        *dst = 0;
   3854 
   3855 
   3856 File: ld.info,  Node: Forced Output Alignment,  Next: Forced Input Alignment,  Prev: Output Section LMA,  Up: Output Section Attributes
   3857 
   3858 3.6.8.3 Forced Output Alignment
   3859 ...............................
   3860 
   3861 You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN.  As an
   3862 alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA
   3863 remains intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT
   3864 attribute.
   3865 
   3866 
   3867 File: ld.info,  Node: Forced Input Alignment,  Next: Output Section Constraint,  Prev: Forced Output Alignment,  Up: Output Section Attributes
   3868 
   3869 3.6.8.4 Forced Input Alignment
   3870 ..............................
   3871 
   3872 You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
   3873 SUBALIGN.  The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
   3874 sections, whether larger or smaller.
   3875 
   3876 
   3877 File: ld.info,  Node: Output Section Constraint,  Next: Output Section Region,  Prev: Forced Input Alignment,  Up: Output Section Attributes
   3878 
   3879 3.6.8.5 Output Section Constraint
   3880 .................................
   3881 
   3882 You can specify that an output section should only be created if all of
   3883 its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
   3884 read-write by using the keyword `ONLY_IF_RO' and `ONLY_IF_RW'
   3885 respectively.
   3886 
   3887 
   3888 File: ld.info,  Node: Output Section Region,  Next: Output Section Phdr,  Prev: Output Section Constraint,  Up: Output Section Attributes
   3889 
   3890 3.6.8.6 Output Section Region
   3891 .............................
   3892 
   3893 You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
   3894 using `>REGION'.  *Note MEMORY::.
   3895 
   3896    Here is a simple example:
   3897      MEMORY { rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 }
   3898      SECTIONS { ROM : { *(.text) } >rom }
   3899 
   3900 
   3901 File: ld.info,  Node: Output Section Phdr,  Next: Output Section Fill,  Prev: Output Section Region,  Up: Output Section Attributes
   3902 
   3903 3.6.8.7 Output Section Phdr
   3904 ...........................
   3905 
   3906 You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
   3907 using `:PHDR'.  *Note PHDRS::.  If a section is assigned to one or more
   3908 segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be assigned to
   3909 those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly `:PHDR' modifier.
   3910 You can use `:NONE' to tell the linker to not put the section in any
   3911 segment at all.
   3912 
   3913    Here is a simple example:
   3914      PHDRS { text PT_LOAD ; }
   3915      SECTIONS { .text : { *(.text) } :text }
   3916 
   3917 
   3918 File: ld.info,  Node: Output Section Fill,  Prev: Output Section Phdr,  Up: Output Section Attributes
   3919 
   3920 3.6.8.8 Output Section Fill
   3921 ...........................
   3922 
   3923 You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using `=FILLEXP'.
   3924 FILLEXP is an expression (*note Expressions::).  Any otherwise
   3925 unspecified regions of memory within the output section (for example,
   3926 gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) will be
   3927 filled with the value, repeated as necessary.  If the fill expression
   3928 is a simple hex number, ie. a string of hex digit starting with `0x'
   3929 and without a trailing `k' or `M', then an arbitrarily long sequence of
   3930 hex digits can be used to specify the fill pattern;  Leading zeros
   3931 become part of the pattern too.  For all other cases, including extra
   3932 parentheses or a unary `+', the fill pattern is the four least
   3933 significant bytes of the value of the expression.  In all cases, the
   3934 number is big-endian.
   3935 
   3936    You can also change the fill value with a `FILL' command in the
   3937 output section commands; (*note Output Section Data::).
   3938 
   3939    Here is a simple example:
   3940      SECTIONS { .text : { *(.text) } =0x90909090 }
   3941 
   3942 
   3943 File: ld.info,  Node: Overlay Description,  Prev: Output Section Attributes,  Up: SECTIONS
   3944 
   3945 3.6.9 Overlay Description
   3946 -------------------------
   3947 
   3948 An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
   3949 are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
   3950 the same memory address.  At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
   3951 copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
   3952 required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits.  This approach
   3953 can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
   3954 than another.
   3955 
   3956    Overlays are described using the `OVERLAY' command.  The `OVERLAY'
   3957 command is used within a `SECTIONS' command, like an output section
   3958 description.  The full syntax of the `OVERLAY' command is as follows:
   3959      OVERLAY [START] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( LDADDR )]
   3960        {
   3961          SECNAME1
   3962            {
   3963              OUTPUT-SECTION-COMMAND
   3964              OUTPUT-SECTION-COMMAND
   3965              ...
   3966            } [:PHDR...] [=FILL]
   3967          SECNAME2
   3968            {
   3969              OUTPUT-SECTION-COMMAND
   3970              OUTPUT-SECTION-COMMAND
   3971              ...
   3972            } [:PHDR...] [=FILL]
   3973          ...
   3974        } [>REGION] [:PHDR...] [=FILL] [,]
   3975 
   3976    Everything is optional except `OVERLAY' (a keyword), and each
   3977 section must have a name (SECNAME1 and SECNAME2 above).  The section
   3978 definitions within the `OVERLAY' construct are identical to those
   3979 within the general `SECTIONS' construct (*note SECTIONS::), except that
   3980 no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for sections within
   3981 an `OVERLAY'.
   3982 
   3983    The comma at the end may be required if a FILL is used and the next
   3984 SECTIONS-COMMAND looks like a continuation of the expression.
   3985 
   3986    The sections are all defined with the same starting address.  The
   3987 load addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are
   3988 consecutive in memory starting at the load address used for the
   3989 `OVERLAY' as a whole (as with normal section definitions, the load
   3990 address is optional, and defaults to the start address; the start
   3991 address is also optional, and defaults to the current value of the
   3992 location counter).
   3993 
   3994    If the `NOCROSSREFS' keyword is used, and there are any references
   3995 among the sections, the linker will report an error.  Since the
   3996 sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make sense
   3997 for one section to refer directly to another.  *Note NOCROSSREFS:
   3998 Miscellaneous Commands.
   3999 
   4000    For each section within the `OVERLAY', the linker automatically
   4001 provides two symbols.  The symbol `__load_start_SECNAME' is defined as
   4002 the starting load address of the section.  The symbol
   4003 `__load_stop_SECNAME' is defined as the final load address of the
   4004 section.  Any characters within SECNAME which are not legal within C
   4005 identifiers are removed.  C (or assembler) code may use these symbols
   4006 to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
   4007 
   4008    At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set
   4009 to the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest
   4010 section.
   4011 
   4012    Here is an example.  Remember that this would appear inside a
   4013 `SECTIONS' construct.
   4014        OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
   4015         {
   4016           .text0 { o1/*.o(.text) }
   4017           .text1 { o2/*.o(.text) }
   4018         }
   4019 This will define both `.text0' and `.text1' to start at address
   4020 0x1000.  `.text0' will be loaded at address 0x4000, and `.text1' will
   4021 be loaded immediately after `.text0'.  The following symbols will be
   4022 defined if referenced: `__load_start_text0', `__load_stop_text0',
   4023 `__load_start_text1', `__load_stop_text1'.
   4024 
   4025    C code to copy overlay `.text1' into the overlay area might look
   4026 like the following.
   4027 
   4028        extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
   4029        memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
   4030                &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
   4031 
   4032    Note that the `OVERLAY' command is just syntactic sugar, since
   4033 everything it does can be done using the more basic commands.  The above
   4034 example could have been written identically as follows.
   4035 
   4036        .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) { o1/*.o(.text) }
   4037        PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
   4038        PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
   4039        .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) { o2/*.o(.text) }
   4040        PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
   4041        PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
   4042        . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
   4043 
   4044 
   4045 File: ld.info,  Node: MEMORY,  Next: PHDRS,  Prev: SECTIONS,  Up: Scripts
   4046 
   4047 3.7 MEMORY Command
   4048 ==================
   4049 
   4050 The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
   4051 memory.  You can override this by using the `MEMORY' command.
   4052 
   4053    The `MEMORY' command describes the location and size of blocks of
   4054 memory in the target.  You can use it to describe which memory regions
   4055 may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid.  You
   4056 can then assign sections to particular memory regions.  The linker will
   4057 set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
   4058 regions that become too full.  The linker will not shuffle sections
   4059 around to fit into the available regions.
   4060 
   4061    A linker script may contain at most one use of the `MEMORY' command.
   4062 However, you can define as many blocks of memory within it as you
   4063 wish.  The syntax is:
   4064      MEMORY
   4065        {
   4066          NAME [(ATTR)] : ORIGIN = ORIGIN, LENGTH = LEN
   4067          ...
   4068        }
   4069 
   4070    The NAME is a name used in the linker script to refer to the region.
   4071 The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.  Region
   4072 names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict with
   4073 symbol names, file names, or section names.  Each memory region must
   4074 have a distinct name within the `MEMORY' command.  However you can add
   4075 later alias names to existing memory regions with the *Note
   4076 REGION_ALIAS:: command.
   4077 
   4078    The ATTR string is an optional list of attributes that specify
   4079 whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
   4080 not explicitly mapped in the linker script.  As described in *Note
   4081 SECTIONS::, if you do not specify an output section for some input
   4082 section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
   4083 the input section.  If you define region attributes, the linker will use
   4084 them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
   4085 
   4086    The ATTR string must consist only of the following characters:
   4087 `R'
   4088      Read-only section
   4089 
   4090 `W'
   4091      Read/write section
   4092 
   4093 `X'
   4094      Executable section
   4095 
   4096 `A'
   4097      Allocatable section
   4098 
   4099 `I'
   4100      Initialized section
   4101 
   4102 `L'
   4103      Same as `I'
   4104 
   4105 `!'
   4106      Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
   4107 
   4108    If a unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
   4109 `!', it will be placed in the memory region.  The `!' attribute
   4110 reverses this test, so that an unmapped section will be placed in the
   4111 memory region only if it does not match any of the listed attributes.
   4112 
   4113    The ORIGIN is an numerical expression for the start address of the
   4114 memory region.  The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
   4115 cannot involve any symbols.  The keyword `ORIGIN' may be abbreviated to
   4116 `org' or `o' (but not, for example, `ORG').
   4117 
   4118    The LEN is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory region.
   4119 As with the ORIGIN expression, the expression must be numerical only
   4120 and must evaluate to a constant.  The keyword `LENGTH' may be
   4121 abbreviated to `len' or `l'.
   4122 
   4123    In the following example, we specify that there are two memory
   4124 regions available for allocation: one starting at `0' for 256 kilobytes,
   4125 and the other starting at `0x40000000' for four megabytes.  The linker
   4126 will place into the `rom' memory region every section which is not
   4127 explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only or
   4128 executable.  The linker will place other sections which are not
   4129 explicitly mapped into a memory region into the `ram' memory region.
   4130 
   4131      MEMORY
   4132        {
   4133          rom (rx)  : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
   4134          ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
   4135        }
   4136 
   4137    Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
   4138 specific output sections into that memory region by using the `>REGION'
   4139 output section attribute.  For example, if you have a memory region
   4140 named `mem', you would use `>mem' in the output section definition.
   4141 *Note Output Section Region::.  If no address was specified for the
   4142 output section, the linker will set the address to the next available
   4143 address within the memory region.  If the combined output sections
   4144 directed to a memory region are too large for the region, the linker
   4145 will issue an error message.
   4146 
   4147    It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
   4148 expression via the `ORIGIN(MEMORY)' and `LENGTH(MEMORY)' functions:
   4149 
   4150        _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
   4151 
   4152 
   4153 File: ld.info,  Node: PHDRS,  Next: VERSION,  Prev: MEMORY,  Up: Scripts
   4154 
   4155 3.8 PHDRS Command
   4156 =================
   4157 
   4158 The ELF object file format uses "program headers", also knows as
   4159 "segments".  The program headers describe how the program should be
   4160 loaded into memory.  You can print them out by using the `objdump'
   4161 program with the `-p' option.
   4162 
   4163    When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
   4164 reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
   4165 program.  This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
   4166 This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
   4167 interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
   4168 
   4169    The linker will create reasonable program headers by default.
   4170 However, in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
   4171 precisely.  You may use the `PHDRS' command for this purpose.  When the
   4172 linker sees the `PHDRS' command in the linker script, it will not
   4173 create any program headers other than the ones specified.
   4174 
   4175    The linker only pays attention to the `PHDRS' command when
   4176 generating an ELF output file.  In other cases, the linker will simply
   4177 ignore `PHDRS'.
   4178 
   4179    This is the syntax of the `PHDRS' command.  The words `PHDRS',
   4180 `FILEHDR', `AT', and `FLAGS' are keywords.
   4181 
   4182      PHDRS
   4183      {
   4184        NAME TYPE [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( ADDRESS ) ]
   4185              [ FLAGS ( FLAGS ) ] ;
   4186      }
   4187 
   4188    The NAME is used only for reference in the `SECTIONS' command of the
   4189 linker script.  It is not put into the output file.  Program header
   4190 names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict with
   4191 symbol names, file names, or section names.  Each program header must
   4192 have a distinct name.  The headers are processed in order and it is
   4193 usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
   4194 
   4195    Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
   4196 system loader will load from the file.  In the linker script, you
   4197 specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
   4198 sections in the segments.  You use the `:PHDR' output section attribute
   4199 to place a section in a particular segment.  *Note Output Section
   4200 Phdr::.
   4201 
   4202    It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment.  This
   4203 merely implies that one segment of memory contains another.  You may
   4204 repeat `:PHDR', using it once for each segment which should contain the
   4205 section.
   4206 
   4207    If you place a section in one or more segments using `:PHDR', then
   4208 the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do not
   4209 specify `:PHDR' in the same segments.  This is for convenience, since
   4210 generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be placed in a single
   4211 segment.  You can use `:NONE' to override the default segment and tell
   4212 the linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
   4213 
   4214    You may use the `FILEHDR' and `PHDRS' keywords after the program
   4215 header type to further describe the contents of the segment.  The
   4216 `FILEHDR' keyword means that the segment should include the ELF file
   4217 header.  The `PHDRS' keyword means that the segment should include the
   4218 ELF program headers themselves.  If applied to a loadable segment
   4219 (`PT_LOAD'), all prior loadable segments must have one of these
   4220 keywords.
   4221 
   4222    The TYPE may be one of the following.  The numbers indicate the
   4223 value of the keyword.
   4224 
   4225 `PT_NULL' (0)
   4226      Indicates an unused program header.
   4227 
   4228 `PT_LOAD' (1)
   4229      Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be
   4230      loaded from the file.
   4231 
   4232 `PT_DYNAMIC' (2)
   4233      Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
   4234 
   4235 `PT_INTERP' (3)
   4236      Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may
   4237      be found.
   4238 
   4239 `PT_NOTE' (4)
   4240      Indicates a segment holding note information.
   4241 
   4242 `PT_SHLIB' (5)
   4243      A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the
   4244      ELF ABI.
   4245 
   4246 `PT_PHDR' (6)
   4247      Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
   4248 
   4249 EXPRESSION
   4250      An expression giving the numeric type of the program header.  This
   4251      may be used for types not defined above.
   4252 
   4253    You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular
   4254 address in memory by using an `AT' expression.  This is identical to the
   4255 `AT' command used as an output section attribute (*note Output Section
   4256 LMA::).  The `AT' command for a program header overrides the output
   4257 section attribute.
   4258 
   4259    The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
   4260 which comprise the segment.  You may use the `FLAGS' keyword to
   4261 explicitly specify the segment flags.  The value of FLAGS must be an
   4262 integer.  It is used to set the `p_flags' field of the program header.
   4263 
   4264    Here is an example of `PHDRS'.  This shows a typical set of program
   4265 headers used on a native ELF system.
   4266 
   4267      PHDRS
   4268      {
   4269        headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
   4270        interp PT_INTERP ;
   4271        text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
   4272        data PT_LOAD ;
   4273        dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
   4274      }
   4275 
   4276      SECTIONS
   4277      {
   4278        . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
   4279        .interp : { *(.interp) } :text :interp
   4280        .text : { *(.text) } :text
   4281        .rodata : { *(.rodata) } /* defaults to :text */
   4282        ...
   4283        . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
   4284        .data : { *(.data) } :data
   4285        .dynamic : { *(.dynamic) } :data :dynamic
   4286        ...
   4287      }
   4288 
   4289 
   4290 File: ld.info,  Node: VERSION,  Next: Expressions,  Prev: PHDRS,  Up: Scripts
   4291 
   4292 3.9 VERSION Command
   4293 ===================
   4294 
   4295 The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF.  Symbol versions are
   4296 only useful when using shared libraries.  The dynamic linker can use
   4297 symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
   4298 a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
   4299 shared library.
   4300 
   4301    You can include a version script directly in the main linker script,
   4302 or you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script.  You
   4303 can also use the `--version-script' linker option.
   4304 
   4305    The syntax of the `VERSION' command is simply
   4306      VERSION { version-script-commands }
   4307 
   4308    The format of the version script commands is identical to that used
   4309 by Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5.  The version script defines a tree of
   4310 version nodes.  You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
   4311 version script.  You can specify which symbols are bound to which
   4312 version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
   4313 scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
   4314 library.
   4315 
   4316    The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a
   4317 few examples.
   4318 
   4319      VERS_1.1 {
   4320      	 global:
   4321      		 foo1;
   4322      	 local:
   4323      		 old*;
   4324      		 original*;
   4325      		 new*;
   4326      };
   4327 
   4328      VERS_1.2 {
   4329      		 foo2;
   4330      } VERS_1.1;
   4331 
   4332      VERS_2.0 {
   4333      		 bar1; bar2;
   4334      	 extern "C++" {
   4335      		 ns::*;
   4336      		 "f(int, double)";
   4337      	 };
   4338      } VERS_1.2;
   4339 
   4340    This example version script defines three version nodes.  The first
   4341 version node defined is `VERS_1.1'; it has no other dependencies.  The
   4342 script binds the symbol `foo1' to `VERS_1.1'.  It reduces a number of
   4343 symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside of the
   4344 shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
   4345 symbol whose name begins with `old', `original', or `new' is matched.
   4346 The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used in the shell
   4347 when matching filenames (also known as "globbing").  However, if you
   4348 specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the name is treated
   4349 as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
   4350 
   4351    Next, the version script defines node `VERS_1.2'.  This node depends
   4352 upon `VERS_1.1'.  The script binds the symbol `foo2' to the version
   4353 node `VERS_1.2'.
   4354 
   4355    Finally, the version script defines node `VERS_2.0'.  This node
   4356 depends upon `VERS_1.2'.  The scripts binds the symbols `bar1' and
   4357 `bar2' are bound to the version node `VERS_2.0'.
   4358 
   4359    When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
   4360 specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
   4361 unspecified base version of the library.  You can bind all otherwise
   4362 unspecified symbols to a given version node by using `global: *;'
   4363 somewhere in the version script.  Note that it's slightly crazy to use
   4364 wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node.  Global
   4365 wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
   4366 set exported for an old version.  That's wrong since older versions
   4367 ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
   4368 
   4369    The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than
   4370 what they might suggest to the person reading them.  The `2.0' version
   4371 could just as well have appeared in between `1.1' and `1.2'.  However,
   4372 this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
   4373 
   4374    Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node in
   4375 the version script.  Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
   4376 symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and
   4377 which won't.
   4378 
   4379      { global: foo; bar; local: *; };
   4380 
   4381    When you link an application against a shared library that has
   4382 versioned symbols, the application itself knows which version of each
   4383 symbol it requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from
   4384 each shared library it is linked against.  Thus at runtime, the dynamic
   4385 loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
   4386 linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
   4387 application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols.  In this
   4388 way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
   4389 all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
   4390 search for each symbol reference.
   4391 
   4392    The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
   4393 doing minor version checking that SunOS does.  The fundamental problem
   4394 that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
   4395 functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
   4396 the application starts up.  If a shared library is out of date, a
   4397 required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
   4398 that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail.  With symbol
   4399 versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
   4400 the libraries being used with the application are too old.
   4401 
   4402    There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach.  The
   4403 first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
   4404 source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
   4405 script.  This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
   4406 maintainer.  You can do this by putting something like:
   4407      __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo (a] VERS_1.1");
   4408    in the C source file.  This renames the function `original_foo' to
   4409 be an alias for `foo' bound to the version node `VERS_1.1'.  The
   4410 `local:' directive can be used to prevent the symbol `original_foo'
   4411 from being exported. A `.symver' directive takes precedence over a
   4412 version script.
   4413 
   4414    The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
   4415 function to appear in a given shared library.  In this way you can make
   4416 an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
   4417 version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
   4418 linked against the old interface to continue to function.
   4419 
   4420    To do this, you must use multiple `.symver' directives in the source
   4421 file.  Here is an example:
   4422 
   4423      __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@");
   4424      __asm__(".symver old_foo,foo (a] VERS_1.1");
   4425      __asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo (a] VERS_1.2");
   4426      __asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@VERS_2.0");
   4427 
   4428    In this example, `foo@' represents the symbol `foo' bound to the
   4429 unspecified base version of the symbol.  The source file that contains
   4430 this example would define 4 C functions: `original_foo', `old_foo',
   4431 `old_foo1', and `new_foo'.
   4432 
   4433    When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to
   4434 be some way to specify a default version to which external references to
   4435 this symbol will be bound.  You can do this with the `foo@@VERS_2.0'
   4436 type of `.symver' directive.  You can only declare one version of a
   4437 symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise you would effectively
   4438 have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
   4439 
   4440    If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
   4441 within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
   4442 (i.e., `old_foo'), or you can use the `.symver' directive to
   4443 specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
   4444 
   4445    You can also specify the language in the version script:
   4446 
   4447      VERSION extern "lang" { version-script-commands }
   4448 
   4449    The supported `lang's are `C', `C++', and `Java'.  The linker will
   4450 iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and demangle them
   4451 according to `lang' before matching them to the patterns specified in
   4452 `version-script-commands'.  The default `lang' is `C'.
   4453 
   4454    Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters.  As
   4455 described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
   4456 or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly.  In
   4457 the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
   4458 whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
   4459 cause a mismatch.  As the exact string generated by the demangler might
   4460 change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you should
   4461 check that all of your version directives are behaving as you expect
   4462 when you upgrade.
   4463 
   4464 
   4465 File: ld.info,  Node: Expressions,  Next: Implicit Linker Scripts,  Prev: VERSION,  Up: Scripts
   4466 
   4467 3.10 Expressions in Linker Scripts
   4468 ==================================
   4469 
   4470 The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
   4471 that of C expressions.  All expressions are evaluated as integers.  All
   4472 expressions are evaluated in the same size, which is 32 bits if both the
   4473 host and target are 32 bits, and is otherwise 64 bits.
   4474 
   4475    You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
   4476 
   4477    The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use
   4478 in expressions.
   4479 
   4480 * Menu:
   4481 
   4482 * Constants::			Constants
   4483 * Symbolic Constants::          Symbolic constants
   4484 * Symbols::			Symbol Names
   4485 * Orphan Sections::		Orphan Sections
   4486 * Location Counter::		The Location Counter
   4487 * Operators::			Operators
   4488 * Evaluation::			Evaluation
   4489 * Expression Section::		The Section of an Expression
   4490 * Builtin Functions::		Builtin Functions
   4491 
   4492 
   4493 File: ld.info,  Node: Constants,  Next: Symbolic Constants,  Up: Expressions
   4494 
   4495 3.10.1 Constants
   4496 ----------------
   4497 
   4498 All constants are integers.
   4499 
   4500    As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with `0' to be
   4501 octal, and an integer beginning with `0x' or `0X' to be hexadecimal.
   4502 Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of `h' or `H' for
   4503 hexadecimal, `o' or `O' for octal, `b' or `B' for binary and `d' or `D'
   4504 for decimal.  Any integer value without a prefix or a suffix is
   4505 considered to be decimal.
   4506 
   4507    In addition, you can use the suffixes `K' and `M' to scale a
   4508 constant by `1024' or `1024*1024' respectively.  For example, the
   4509 following all refer to the same quantity:
   4510 
   4511      _fourk_1 = 4K;
   4512      _fourk_2 = 4096;
   4513      _fourk_3 = 0x1000;
   4514      _fourk_4 = 10000o;
   4515 
   4516    Note - the `K' and `M' suffixes cannot be used in conjunction with
   4517 the base suffixes mentioned above.
   4518 
   4519 
   4520 File: ld.info,  Node: Symbolic Constants,  Next: Symbols,  Prev: Constants,  Up: Expressions
   4521 
   4522 3.10.2 Symbolic Constants
   4523 -------------------------
   4524 
   4525 It is possible to refer to target specific constants via the use of the
   4526 `CONSTANT(NAME)' operator, where NAME is one of:
   4527 
   4528 `MAXPAGESIZE'
   4529      The target's maximum page size.
   4530 
   4531 `COMMONPAGESIZE'
   4532      The target's default page size.
   4533 
   4534    So for example:
   4535 
   4536        .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : { *(.text) }
   4537 
   4538    will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
   4539 supported by the target.
   4540 
   4541 
   4542 File: ld.info,  Node: Symbols,  Next: Orphan Sections,  Prev: Symbolic Constants,  Up: Expressions
   4543 
   4544 3.10.3 Symbol Names
   4545 -------------------
   4546 
   4547 Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
   4548 and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
   4549 Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords.  You can
   4550 specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
   4551 keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
   4552      "SECTION" = 9;
   4553      "with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
   4554 
   4555    Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is
   4556 safest to delimit symbols with spaces.  For example, `A-B' is one
   4557 symbol, whereas `A - B' is an expression involving subtraction.
   4558 
   4559 
   4560 File: ld.info,  Node: Orphan Sections,  Next: Location Counter,  Prev: Symbols,  Up: Expressions
   4561 
   4562 3.10.4 Orphan Sections
   4563 ----------------------
   4564 
   4565 Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which are not
   4566 explicitly placed into the output file by the linker script.  The
   4567 linker will still copy these sections into the output file, but it has
   4568 to guess as to where they should be placed.  The linker uses a simple
   4569 heuristic to do this.  It attempts to place orphan sections after
   4570 non-orphan sections of the same attribute, such as code vs data,
   4571 loadable vs non-loadable, etc.  If there is not enough room to do this
   4572 then it places at the end of the file.
   4573 
   4574    For ELF targets, the attribute of the section includes section type
   4575 as well as section flag.
   4576 
   4577    If an orphaned section's name is representable as a C identifier then
   4578 the linker will automatically *note PROVIDE:: two symbols:
   4579 __start_SECNAME and __stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the
   4580 section.  These indicate the start address and end address of the
   4581 orphaned section respectively.  Note: most section names are not
   4582 representable as C identifiers because they contain a `.' character.
   4583 
   4584 
   4585 File: ld.info,  Node: Location Counter,  Next: Operators,  Prev: Orphan Sections,  Up: Expressions
   4586 
   4587 3.10.5 The Location Counter
   4588 ---------------------------
   4589 
   4590 The special linker variable "dot" `.' always contains the current
   4591 output location counter.  Since the `.' always refers to a location in
   4592 an output section, it may only appear in an expression within a
   4593 `SECTIONS' command.  The `.' symbol may appear anywhere that an
   4594 ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
   4595 
   4596    Assigning a value to `.' will cause the location counter to be
   4597 moved.  This may be used to create holes in the output section.  The
   4598 location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
   4599 and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so doing
   4600 creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
   4601 
   4602      SECTIONS
   4603      {
   4604        output :
   4605          {
   4606            file1(.text)
   4607            . = . + 1000;
   4608            file2(.text)
   4609            . += 1000;
   4610            file3(.text)
   4611          } = 0x12345678;
   4612      }
   4613    In the previous example, the `.text' section from `file1' is located
   4614 at the beginning of the output section `output'.  It is followed by a
   4615 1000 byte gap.  Then the `.text' section from `file2' appears, also
   4616 with a 1000 byte gap following before the `.text' section from `file3'.
   4617 The notation `= 0x12345678' specifies what data to write in the gaps
   4618 (*note Output Section Fill::).
   4619 
   4620    Note: `.' actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
   4621 current containing object.  Normally this is the `SECTIONS' statement,
   4622 whose start address is 0, hence `.' can be used as an absolute address.
   4623 If `.' is used inside a section description however, it refers to the
   4624 byte offset from the start of that section, not an absolute address.
   4625 Thus in a script like this:
   4626 
   4627      SECTIONS
   4628      {
   4629          . = 0x100
   4630          .text: {
   4631            *(.text)
   4632            . = 0x200
   4633          }
   4634          . = 0x500
   4635          .data: {
   4636            *(.data)
   4637            . += 0x600
   4638          }
   4639      }
   4640 
   4641    The `.text' section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100 and
   4642 a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in the
   4643 `.text' input sections to fill this area.  (If there is too much data,
   4644 an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to move `.'
   4645 backwards).  The `.data' section will start at 0x500 and it will have
   4646 an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of the values from
   4647 the `.data' input sections and before the end of the `.data' output
   4648 section itself.
   4649 
   4650    Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
   4651 output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
   4652 needs to place orphan sections.  For example, given the following:
   4653 
   4654      SECTIONS
   4655      {
   4656          start_of_text = . ;
   4657          .text: { *(.text) }
   4658          end_of_text = . ;
   4659 
   4660          start_of_data = . ;
   4661          .data: { *(.data) }
   4662          end_of_data = . ;
   4663      }
   4664 
   4665    If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. `.rodata', not
   4666 mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section between
   4667 `.text' and `.data'.  You might think the linker should place `.rodata'
   4668 on the blank line in the above script, but blank lines are of no
   4669 particular significance to the linker.  As well, the linker doesn't
   4670 associate the above symbol names with their sections.  Instead, it
   4671 assumes that all assignments or other statements belong to the previous
   4672 output section, except for the special case of an assignment to `.'.
   4673 I.e., the linker will place the orphan `.rodata' section as if the
   4674 script was written as follows:
   4675 
   4676      SECTIONS
   4677      {
   4678          start_of_text = . ;
   4679          .text: { *(.text) }
   4680          end_of_text = . ;
   4681 
   4682          start_of_data = . ;
   4683          .rodata: { *(.rodata) }
   4684          .data: { *(.data) }
   4685          end_of_data = . ;
   4686      }
   4687 
   4688    This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
   4689 `start_of_data'.  One way to influence the orphan section placement is
   4690 to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker assumes that an
   4691 assignment to `.' is setting the start address of a following output
   4692 section and thus should be grouped with that section.  So you could
   4693 write:
   4694 
   4695      SECTIONS
   4696      {
   4697          start_of_text = . ;
   4698          .text: { *(.text) }
   4699          end_of_text = . ;
   4700 
   4701          . = . ;
   4702          start_of_data = . ;
   4703          .data: { *(.data) }
   4704          end_of_data = . ;
   4705      }
   4706 
   4707    Now, the orphan `.rodata' section will be placed between
   4708 `end_of_text' and `start_of_data'.
   4709 
   4710 
   4711 File: ld.info,  Node: Operators,  Next: Evaluation,  Prev: Location Counter,  Up: Expressions
   4712 
   4713 3.10.6 Operators
   4714 ----------------
   4715 
   4716 The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
   4717 the standard bindings and precedence levels:
   4718      precedence      associativity   Operators                Notes
   4719      (highest)
   4720      1               left            !  -  ~                  (1)
   4721      2               left            *  /  %
   4722      3               left            +  -
   4723      4               left            >>  <<
   4724      5               left            ==  !=  >  <  <=  >=
   4725      6               left            &
   4726      7               left            |
   4727      8               left            &&
   4728      9               left            ||
   4729      10              right           ? :
   4730      11              right           &=  +=  -=  *=  /=       (2)
   4731      (lowest)
   4732    Notes: (1) Prefix operators (2) *Note Assignments::.
   4733 
   4734 
   4735 File: ld.info,  Node: Evaluation,  Next: Expression Section,  Prev: Operators,  Up: Expressions
   4736 
   4737 3.10.7 Evaluation
   4738 -----------------
   4739 
   4740 The linker evaluates expressions lazily.  It only computes the value of
   4741 an expression when absolutely necessary.
   4742 
   4743    The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
   4744 address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
   4745 regions, in order to do any linking at all.  These values are computed
   4746 as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
   4747 
   4748    However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
   4749 until after storage allocation.  Such values are evaluated later, when
   4750 other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
   4751 for use in the symbol assignment expression.
   4752 
   4753    The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
   4754 assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
   4755 allocation.
   4756 
   4757    Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
   4758 `.', must be evaluated during section allocation.
   4759 
   4760    If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
   4761 available, then an error results.  For example, a script like the
   4762 following
   4763      SECTIONS
   4764        {
   4765          .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
   4766            { *(.text) }
   4767        }
   4768 will cause the error message `non constant expression for initial
   4769 address'.
   4770 
   4771 
   4772 File: ld.info,  Node: Expression Section,  Next: Builtin Functions,  Prev: Evaluation,  Up: Expressions
   4773 
   4774 3.10.8 The Section of an Expression
   4775 -----------------------------------
   4776 
   4777 Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute.  A section
   4778 relative symbol is relocatable.  If you request relocatable output
   4779 using the `-r' option, a further link operation may change the value of
   4780 a section relative symbol.  On the other hand, an absolute symbol will
   4781 retain the same value throughout any further link operations.
   4782 
   4783    Some terms in linker expressions are addresses.  This is true of
   4784 section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
   4785 address, such as `ADDR', `LOADADDR', `ORIGIN' and `SEGMENT_START'.
   4786 Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin functions that return a
   4787 non-address value, such as `LENGTH'.  One complication is that unless
   4788 you set `LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")' (*note Miscellaneous Commands::),
   4789 numbers and absolute symbols are treated differently depending on their
   4790 location, for compatibility with older versions of `ld'.  Expressions
   4791 appearing outside an output section definition treat all numbers as
   4792 absolute addresses.  Expressions appearing inside an output section
   4793 definition treat absolute symbols as numbers.  If `LD_FEATURE
   4794 ("SANE_EXPR")' is given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply
   4795 treated as numbers everywhere.
   4796 
   4797    In the following simple example,
   4798 
   4799      SECTIONS
   4800        {
   4801          . = 0x100;
   4802          __executable_start = 0x100;
   4803          .data :
   4804          {
   4805            . = 0x10;
   4806            __data_start = 0x10;
   4807            *(.data)
   4808          }
   4809          ...
   4810        }
   4811 
   4812    both `.' and `__executable_start' are set to the absolute address
   4813 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both `.' and `__data_start'
   4814 are set to 0x10 relative to the `.data' section in the second two
   4815 assignments.
   4816 
   4817    For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
   4818 addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
   4819 
   4820    * Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
   4821      operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
   4822      absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
   4823 
   4824    * Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on
   4825      two relative addresses in the same section or between one relative
   4826      address and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the
   4827      address(es).
   4828 
   4829    * Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses
   4830      not in the same section, or between a relative address and an
   4831      absolute address, first convert any non-absolute term to an
   4832      absolute address before applying the operator.
   4833 
   4834    The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
   4835 
   4836    * An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
   4837 
   4838    * The result of comparisons, `&&' and `||' is also a number.
   4839 
   4840    * The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
   4841      relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
   4842      (after above conversions) is also a number.
   4843 
   4844    * The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
   4845      relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
   4846      section as the relative operand(s).
   4847 
   4848    * The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
   4849      conversions) is an absolute address.
   4850 
   4851    You can use the builtin function `ABSOLUTE' to force an expression
   4852 to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative.  For example, to
   4853 create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
   4854 section `.data':
   4855      SECTIONS
   4856        {
   4857          .data : { *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); }
   4858        }
   4859    If `ABSOLUTE' were not used, `_edata' would be relative to the
   4860 `.data' section.
   4861 
   4862    Using `LOADADDR' also forces an expression absolute, since this
   4863 particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
   4864 
   4865 
   4866 File: ld.info,  Node: Builtin Functions,  Prev: Expression Section,  Up: Expressions
   4867 
   4868 3.10.9 Builtin Functions
   4869 ------------------------
   4870 
   4871 The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
   4872 use in linker script expressions.
   4873 
   4874 `ABSOLUTE(EXP)'
   4875      Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative)
   4876      value of the expression EXP.  Primarily useful to assign an
   4877      absolute value to a symbol within a section definition, where
   4878      symbol values are normally section relative.  *Note Expression
   4879      Section::.
   4880 
   4881 `ADDR(SECTION)'
   4882      Return the address (VMA) of the named SECTION.  Your script must
   4883      previously have defined the location of that section.  In the
   4884      following example, `start_of_output_1', `symbol_1' and `symbol_2'
   4885      are assigned equivalent values, except that `symbol_1' will be
   4886      relative to the `.output1' section while the other two will be
   4887      absolute:
   4888           SECTIONS { ...
   4889             .output1 :
   4890               {
   4891               start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
   4892               ...
   4893               }
   4894             .output :
   4895               {
   4896               symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
   4897               symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
   4898               }
   4899           ... }
   4900 
   4901 `ALIGN(ALIGN)'
   4902 `ALIGN(EXP,ALIGN)'
   4903      Return the location counter (`.') or arbitrary expression aligned
   4904      to the next ALIGN boundary.  The single operand `ALIGN' doesn't
   4905      change the value of the location counter--it just does arithmetic
   4906      on it.  The two operand `ALIGN' allows an arbitrary expression to
   4907      be aligned upwards (`ALIGN(ALIGN)' is equivalent to `ALIGN(.,
   4908      ALIGN)').
   4909 
   4910      Here is an example which aligns the output `.data' section to the
   4911      next `0x2000' byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
   4912      variable within the section to the next `0x8000' boundary after the
   4913      input sections:
   4914           SECTIONS { ...
   4915             .data ALIGN(0x2000): {
   4916               *(.data)
   4917               variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
   4918             }
   4919           ... }
   4920      The first use of `ALIGN' in this example specifies the
   4921      location of a section because it is used as the optional ADDRESS
   4922      attribute of a section definition (*note Output Section
   4923      Address::).  The second use of `ALIGN' is used to defines the
   4924      value of a symbol.
   4925 
   4926      The builtin function `NEXT' is closely related to `ALIGN'.
   4927 
   4928 `ALIGNOF(SECTION)'
   4929      Return the alignment in bytes of the named SECTION, if that
   4930      section has been allocated.  If the section has not been allocated
   4931      when this is evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the
   4932      following example, the alignment of the `.output' section is
   4933      stored as the first value in that section.
   4934           SECTIONS{ ...
   4935             .output {
   4936               LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
   4937               ...
   4938               }
   4939           ... }
   4940 
   4941 `BLOCK(EXP)'
   4942      This is a synonym for `ALIGN', for compatibility with older linker
   4943      scripts.  It is most often seen when setting the address of an
   4944      output section.
   4945 
   4946 `DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(MAXPAGESIZE, COMMONPAGESIZE)'
   4947      This is equivalent to either
   4948           (ALIGN(MAXPAGESIZE) + (. & (MAXPAGESIZE - 1)))
   4949      or
   4950           (ALIGN(MAXPAGESIZE) + (. & (MAXPAGESIZE - COMMONPAGESIZE)))
   4951      depending on whether the latter uses fewer COMMONPAGESIZE sized
   4952      pages for the data segment (area between the result of this
   4953      expression and `DATA_SEGMENT_END') than the former or not.  If the
   4954      latter form is used, it means COMMONPAGESIZE bytes of runtime
   4955      memory will be saved at the expense of up to COMMONPAGESIZE wasted
   4956      bytes in the on-disk file.
   4957 
   4958      This expression can only be used directly in `SECTIONS' commands,
   4959      not in any output section descriptions and only once in the linker
   4960      script.  COMMONPAGESIZE should be less or equal to MAXPAGESIZE and
   4961      should be the system page size the object wants to be optimized
   4962      for (while still working on system page sizes up to MAXPAGESIZE).
   4963 
   4964      Example:
   4965             . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
   4966 
   4967 `DATA_SEGMENT_END(EXP)'
   4968      This defines the end of data segment for `DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN'
   4969      evaluation purposes.
   4970 
   4971             . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
   4972 
   4973 `DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(OFFSET, EXP)'
   4974      This defines the end of the `PT_GNU_RELRO' segment when `-z relro'
   4975      option is used.  When `-z relro' option is not present,
   4976      `DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END' does nothing, otherwise
   4977      `DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN' is padded so that EXP + OFFSET is aligned to
   4978      the most commonly used page boundary for particular target.  If
   4979      present in the linker script, it must always come in between
   4980      `DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN' and `DATA_SEGMENT_END'.  Evaluates to the
   4981      second argument plus any padding needed at the end of the
   4982      `PT_GNU_RELRO' segment due to section alignment.
   4983 
   4984             . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
   4985 
   4986 `DEFINED(SYMBOL)'
   4987      Return 1 if SYMBOL is in the linker global symbol table and is
   4988      defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
   4989      return 0.  You can use this function to provide default values for
   4990      symbols.  For example, the following script fragment shows how to
   4991      set a global symbol `begin' to the first location in the `.text'
   4992      section--but if a symbol called `begin' already existed, its value
   4993      is preserved:
   4994 
   4995           SECTIONS { ...
   4996             .text : {
   4997               begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
   4998               ...
   4999             }
   5000             ...
   5001           }
   5002 
   5003 `LENGTH(MEMORY)'
   5004      Return the length of the memory region named MEMORY.
   5005 
   5006 `LOADADDR(SECTION)'
   5007      Return the absolute LMA of the named SECTION.  (*note Output
   5008      Section LMA::).
   5009 
   5010 `LOG2CEIL(EXP)'
   5011      Return the binary logarithm of EXP rounded towards infinity.
   5012      `LOG2CEIL(0)' returns 0.
   5013 
   5014 `MAX(EXP1, EXP2)'
   5015      Returns the maximum of EXP1 and EXP2.
   5016 
   5017 `MIN(EXP1, EXP2)'
   5018      Returns the minimum of EXP1 and EXP2.
   5019 
   5020 `NEXT(EXP)'
   5021      Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of EXP.
   5022      This function is closely related to `ALIGN(EXP)'; unless you use
   5023      the `MEMORY' command to define discontinuous memory for the output
   5024      file, the two functions are equivalent.
   5025 
   5026 `ORIGIN(MEMORY)'
   5027      Return the origin of the memory region named MEMORY.
   5028 
   5029 `SEGMENT_START(SEGMENT, DEFAULT)'
   5030      Return the base address of the named SEGMENT.  If an explicit
   5031      value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
   5032      `-T' option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
   5033      will be DEFAULT.  At present, the `-T' command-line option can
   5034      only be used to set the base address for the "text", "data", and
   5035      "bss" sections, but you can use `SEGMENT_START' with any segment
   5036      name.
   5037 
   5038 `SIZEOF(SECTION)'
   5039      Return the size in bytes of the named SECTION, if that section has
   5040      been allocated.  If the section has not been allocated when this is
   5041      evaluated, the linker will report an error.  In the following
   5042      example, `symbol_1' and `symbol_2' are assigned identical values:
   5043           SECTIONS{ ...
   5044             .output {
   5045               .start = . ;
   5046               ...
   5047               .end = . ;
   5048               }
   5049             symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
   5050             symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
   5051           ... }
   5052 
   5053 `SIZEOF_HEADERS'
   5054 `sizeof_headers'
   5055      Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers.  This is
   5056      information which appears at the start of the output file.  You
   5057      can use this number when setting the start address of the first
   5058      section, if you choose, to facilitate paging.
   5059 
   5060      When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
   5061      `SIZEOF_HEADERS' builtin function, the linker must compute the
   5062      number of program headers before it has determined all the section
   5063      addresses and sizes.  If the linker later discovers that it needs
   5064      additional program headers, it will report an error `not enough
   5065      room for program headers'.  To avoid this error, you must avoid
   5066      using the `SIZEOF_HEADERS' function, or you must rework your linker
   5067      script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program
   5068      headers, or you must define the program headers yourself using the
   5069      `PHDRS' command (*note PHDRS::).
   5070 
   5071 
   5072 File: ld.info,  Node: Implicit Linker Scripts,  Prev: Expressions,  Up: Scripts
   5073 
   5074 3.11 Implicit Linker Scripts
   5075 ============================
   5076 
   5077 If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
   5078 an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
   5079 linker script.  If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
   5080 linker will report an error.
   5081 
   5082    An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
   5083 
   5084    Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
   5085 assignments, or the `INPUT', `GROUP', or `VERSION' commands.
   5086 
   5087    Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be
   5088 read at the position in the command line where the implicit linker
   5089 script was read.  This can affect archive searching.
   5090 
   5091 
   5092 File: ld.info,  Node: Machine Dependent,  Next: BFD,  Prev: Scripts,  Up: Top
   5093 
   5094 4 Machine Dependent Features
   5095 ****************************
   5096 
   5097 `ld' has additional features on some platforms; the following sections
   5098 describe them.  Machines where `ld' has no additional functionality are
   5099 not listed.
   5100 
   5101 * Menu:
   5102 
   5103 
   5104 * H8/300::                      `ld' and the H8/300
   5105 
   5106 * i960::                        `ld' and the Intel 960 family
   5107 
   5108 * M68HC11/68HC12::		`ld' and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
   5109 
   5110 * ARM::				`ld' and the ARM family
   5111 
   5112 * HPPA ELF32::                  `ld' and HPPA 32-bit ELF
   5113 
   5114 * M68K::			`ld' and the Motorola 68K family
   5115 
   5116 * MIPS::			`ld' and the MIPS family
   5117 
   5118 * MMIX::			`ld' and MMIX
   5119 
   5120 * MSP430::			`ld' and MSP430
   5121 
   5122 * NDS32::			`ld' and NDS32
   5123 
   5124 * Nios II::			`ld' and the Altera Nios II
   5125 
   5126 * PowerPC ELF32::		`ld' and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
   5127 
   5128 * PowerPC64 ELF64::		`ld' and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
   5129 
   5130 * SPU ELF::			`ld' and SPU ELF Support
   5131 
   5132 * TI COFF::                     `ld' and TI COFF
   5133 
   5134 * WIN32::                       `ld' and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
   5135 
   5136 * Xtensa::                      `ld' and Xtensa Processors
   5137 
   5138 
   5139 File: ld.info,  Node: H8/300,  Next: i960,  Up: Machine Dependent
   5140 
   5141 4.1 `ld' and the H8/300
   5142 =======================
   5143 
   5144 For the H8/300, `ld' can perform these global optimizations when you
   5145 specify the `--relax' command-line option.
   5146 
   5147 _relaxing address modes_
   5148      `ld' finds all `jsr' and `jmp' instructions whose targets are
   5149      within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit program-counter
   5150      relative `bsr' and `bra' instructions, respectively.
   5151 
   5152 _synthesizing instructions_
   5153      `ld' finds all `mov.b' instructions which use the sixteen-bit
   5154      absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
   5155      changes them to use the eight-bit address form.  (That is: the
   5156      linker turns `mov.b `@'AA:16' into `mov.b `@'AA:8' whenever the
   5157      address AA is in the top page of memory).
   5158 
   5159      `ld' finds all `mov' instructions which use the register indirect
   5160      with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
   5161      displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to
   5162      use the 16-bit displacement form.  (That is: the linker turns
   5163      `mov.b `@'D:32,ERx' into `mov.b `@'D:16,ERx' whenever the
   5164      displacement D is in the 16 bit signed integer range. Only
   5165      implemented in ELF-format ld).
   5166 
   5167 _bit manipulation instructions_
   5168      `ld' finds all bit manipulation instructions like `band, bclr,
   5169      biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst,
   5170      bxor' which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer
   5171      to the top page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit
   5172      address form.  (That is: the linker turns `bset #xx:3,`@'AA:32'
   5173      into `bset #xx:3,`@'AA:8' whenever the address AA is in the top
   5174      page of memory).
   5175 
   5176 _system control instructions_
   5177      `ld' finds all `ldc.w, stc.w' instructions which use the 32 bit
   5178      absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
   5179      changes them to use 16 bit address form.  (That is: the linker
   5180      turns `ldc.w `@'AA:32,ccr' into `ldc.w `@'AA:16,ccr' whenever the
   5181      address AA is in the top page of memory).
   5182 
   5183 
   5184 File: ld.info,  Node: i960,  Next: M68HC11/68HC12,  Prev: H8/300,  Up: Machine Dependent
   5185 
   5186 4.2 `ld' and the Intel 960 Family
   5187 =================================
   5188 
   5189 You can use the `-AARCHITECTURE' command line option to specify one of
   5190 the two-letter names identifying members of the 960 family; the option
   5191 specifies the desired output target, and warns of any incompatible
   5192 instructions in the input files.  It also modifies the linker's search
   5193 strategy for archive libraries, to support the use of libraries
   5194 specific to each particular architecture, by including in the search
   5195 loop names suffixed with the string identifying the architecture.
   5196 
   5197    For example, if your `ld' command line included `-ACA' as well as
   5198 `-ltry', the linker would look (in its built-in search paths, and in
   5199 any paths you specify with `-L') for a library with the names
   5200 
   5201      try
   5202      libtry.a
   5203      tryca
   5204      libtryca.a
   5205 
   5206 The first two possibilities would be considered in any event; the last
   5207 two are due to the use of `-ACA'.
   5208 
   5209    You can meaningfully use `-A' more than once on a command line, since
   5210 the 960 architecture family allows combination of target architectures;
   5211 each use will add another pair of name variants to search for when `-l'
   5212 specifies a library.
   5213 
   5214    `ld' supports the `--relax' option for the i960 family.  If you
   5215 specify `--relax', `ld' finds all `balx' and `calx' instructions whose
   5216 targets are within 24 bits, and turns them into 24-bit program-counter
   5217 relative `bal' and `cal' instructions, respectively.  `ld' also turns
   5218 `cal' instructions into `bal' instructions when it determines that the
   5219 target subroutine is a leaf routine (that is, the target subroutine does
   5220 not itself call any subroutines).
   5221 
   5222 
   5223 File: ld.info,  Node: M68HC11/68HC12,  Next: ARM,  Prev: i960,  Up: Machine Dependent
   5224 
   5225 4.3 `ld' and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
   5226 ====================================================
   5227 
   5228 4.3.1 Linker Relaxation
   5229 -----------------------
   5230 
   5231 For the Motorola 68HC11, `ld' can perform these global optimizations
   5232 when you specify the `--relax' command-line option.
   5233 
   5234 _relaxing address modes_
   5235      `ld' finds all `jsr' and `jmp' instructions whose targets are
   5236      within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit program-counter
   5237      relative `bsr' and `bra' instructions, respectively.
   5238 
   5239      `ld' also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
   5240      transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
   5241      page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
   5242 
   5243 _relaxing gcc instruction group_
   5244      When `gcc' is called with `-mrelax', it can emit group of
   5245      instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
   5246      addressing mode. These instructions consists of `bclr' or `bset'
   5247      instructions.
   5248 
   5249 
   5250 4.3.2 Trampoline Generation
   5251 ---------------------------
   5252 
   5253 For 68HC11 and 68HC12, `ld' can generate trampoline code to call a far
   5254 function using a normal `jsr' instruction. The linker will also change
   5255 the relocation to some far function to use the trampoline address
   5256 instead of the function address. This is typically the case when a
   5257 pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact point to the
   5258 function trampoline.
   5259 
   5260 
   5261 File: ld.info,  Node: ARM,  Next: HPPA ELF32,  Prev: M68HC11/68HC12,  Up: Machine Dependent
   5262 
   5263 4.4 `ld' and the ARM family
   5264 ===========================
   5265 
   5266 For the ARM, `ld' will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
   5267 between ARM and Thumb code.  These stubs only work with code that has
   5268 been compiled and assembled with the `-mthumb-interwork' command line
   5269 option.  If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
   5270 libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
   5271 option then the `--support-old-code' command line switch should be
   5272 given to the linker.  This will make it generate larger stub functions
   5273 which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code.  Note, however,
   5274 the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
   5275 non-interworking aware Thumb code.
   5276 
   5277    The `--thumb-entry' switch is a duplicate of the generic `--entry'
   5278 switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.  But it also
   5279 sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be branched to using
   5280 a BX instruction, and the program will start executing in Thumb mode
   5281 straight away.
   5282 
   5283    The `--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables' switch is specifying, that
   5284 the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
   5285 element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
   5286 import tables. By default this option is turned off.
   5287 
   5288    The `--be8' switch instructs `ld' to generate BE8 format
   5289 executables.  This option is only valid when linking big-endian objects.
   5290 The resulting image will contain big-endian data and little-endian code.
   5291 
   5292    The `R_ARM_TARGET1' relocation is typically used for entries in the
   5293 `.init_array' section.  It is interpreted as either `R_ARM_REL32' or
   5294 `R_ARM_ABS32', depending on the target.  The `--target1-rel' and
   5295 `--target1-abs' switches override the default.
   5296 
   5297    The `--target2=type' switch overrides the default definition of the
   5298 `R_ARM_TARGET2' relocation.  Valid values for `type', their meanings,
   5299 and target defaults are as follows:
   5300 `rel'
   5301      `R_ARM_REL32' (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
   5302 
   5303 `abs'
   5304      `R_ARM_ABS32' (arm*-*-symbianelf)
   5305 
   5306 `got-rel'
   5307      `R_ARM_GOT_PREL' (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
   5308 
   5309    The `R_ARM_V4BX' relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF specification)
   5310 enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
   5311 interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t,
   5312 but also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4
   5313 objects.
   5314 
   5315    In the latter case, the switch `--fix-v4bx' must be passed to the
   5316 linker, which causes v4t `BX rM' instructions to be rewritten as `MOV
   5317 PC,rM', since v4 processors do not have a `BX' instruction.
   5318 
   5319    In the former case, the switch should not be used, and `R_ARM_V4BX'
   5320 relocations are ignored.
   5321 
   5322    Replace `BX rM' instructions identified by `R_ARM_V4BX' relocations
   5323 with a branch to the following veneer:
   5324 
   5325      TST rM, #1
   5326      MOVEQ PC, rM
   5327      BX Rn
   5328 
   5329    This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4
   5330 cores and are still interworking safe.  Note that the above veneer
   5331 clobbers the condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior
   5332 in rare cases.
   5333 
   5334    The `--use-blx' switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb BLX
   5335 instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various situations.
   5336 Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb code using
   5337 BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before each PLT
   5338 entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
   5339 
   5340    This option is enabled implicitly for SymbianOS, so there is no need
   5341 to specify it if you are using that target.
   5342 
   5343    The `--vfp11-denorm-fix' switch enables a link-time workaround for a
   5344 bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
   5345 instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support
   5346 code) to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions
   5347 before the support code can read the intended values.
   5348 
   5349    The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
   5350 intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a
   5351 register and another instruction which writes to the same register, or
   5352 at least two intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug
   5353 only affects full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this
   5354 workaround if you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for
   5355 further details.
   5356 
   5357    If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can enable this
   5358 workaround by specifying the linker option `--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar' if
   5359 you are using the VFP11 scalar mode only, or `--vfp-denorm-fix=vector'
   5360 if you are using vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code).
   5361 The default is `--vfp-denorm-fix=none'.
   5362 
   5363    If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
   5364 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
   5365 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
   5366 first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
   5367 instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
   5368 the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
   5369 are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
   5370 
   5371    The `--fix-arm1176' switch enables a link-time workaround for an
   5372 erratum in certain ARM1176 processors.  The workaround is enabled by
   5373 default if you are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier.
   5374 It can be disabled unconditionally by specifying `--no-fix-arm1176'.
   5375 
   5376    Further information is available in the "ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
   5377 Programmer Advice Notice" available on the ARM documentation website at:
   5378 http://infocenter.arm.com/.
   5379 
   5380    The `--no-enum-size-warning' switch prevents the linker from warning
   5381 when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI enumeration
   5382 size attributes.  For example, with this switch enabled, linking of an
   5383 object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another using
   5384 enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will not be
   5385 diagnosed.
   5386 
   5387    The `--no-wchar-size-warning' switch prevents the linker from
   5388 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
   5389 `wchar_t' size attributes.  For example, with this switch enabled,
   5390 linking of an object file using 32-bit `wchar_t' values with another
   5391 using 16-bit `wchar_t' values will not be diagnosed.
   5392 
   5393    The `--pic-veneer' switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
   5394 ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary is not
   5395 PIC.  This avoids problems on uClinux targets where `--emit-relocs' is
   5396 used to generate relocatable binaries.
   5397 
   5398    The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
   5399 code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
   5400 perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away.  The
   5401 placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
   5402 controlled by the command line option `--stub-group-size=N'.  The
   5403 placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
   5404 duplicate stubs, increasing the code size.  The linker will try to
   5405 group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
   5406 code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
   5407 where they should be placed.
   5408 
   5409    The value of `N', the parameter to the `--stub-group-size=' option
   5410 controls where the stub groups are placed.  If it is negative then all
   5411 stubs are placed after the first branch that needs them.  If it is
   5412 positive then the stubs can be placed either before or after the
   5413 branches that need them.  If the value of `N' is 1 (either +1 or -1)
   5414 then the linker will choose exactly where to place groups of stubs,
   5415 using its built in heuristics.  A value of `N' greater than 1 (or
   5416 smaller than -1) tells the linker that a single group of stubs can
   5417 service at most `N' bytes from the input sections.
   5418 
   5419    The default, if `--stub-group-size=' is not specified, is `N = +1'.
   5420 
   5421    Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
   5422 only, because it relies on object files properties not present
   5423 otherwise.
   5424 
   5425    The `--fix-cortex-a8' switch enables a link-time workaround for an
   5426 erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors.  The workaround is enabled by
   5427 default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile.  It can
   5428 be enabled otherwise by specifying `--fix-cortex-a8', or disabled
   5429 unconditionally by specifying `--no-fix-cortex-a8'.
   5430 
   5431    The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code.  Please contact ARM for
   5432 further details.
   5433 
   5434    The `--fix-cortex-a53-835769' switch enables a link-time workaround
   5435 for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53
   5436 processors.  The workaround is disabled by default.  It can be enabled
   5437 by specifying `--fix-cortex-a53-835769', or disabled unconditionally by
   5438 specifying `--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769'.
   5439 
   5440    Please contact ARM for further details.
   5441 
   5442    The `--no-merge-exidx-entries' switch disables the merging of
   5443 adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
   5444 
   5445    The `--long-plt' option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries which
   5446 support up to 4Gb of code.  The default is to use 12 byte PLT entries
   5447 which only support 512Mb of code.
   5448 
   5449 
   5450 File: ld.info,  Node: HPPA ELF32,  Next: M68K,  Prev: ARM,  Up: Machine Dependent
   5451 
   5452 4.5 `ld' and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
   5453 ====================================
   5454 
   5455 When generating a shared library, `ld' will by default generate import
   5456 stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.  The
   5457 `--multi-subspace' switch causes `ld' to generate export stubs, and
   5458 different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with multiple
   5459 sub-spaces.
   5460 
   5461    Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by `ld' in stub
   5462 sections located between groups of input sections.  `--stub-group-size'
   5463 specifies the maximum size of a group of input sections handled by one
   5464 stub section.  Since branch offsets are signed, a stub section may
   5465 serve two groups of input sections, one group before the stub section,
   5466 and one group after it.  However, when using conditional branches that
   5467 require stubs, it may be better (for branch prediction) that stub
   5468 sections only serve one group of input sections.  A negative value for
   5469 `N' chooses this scheme, ensuring that branches to stubs always use a
   5470 negative offset.  Two special values of `N' are recognized, `1' and
   5471 `-1'.  These both instruct `ld' to automatically size input section
   5472 groups for the branch types detected, with the same behaviour regarding
   5473 stub placement as other positive or negative values of `N' respectively.
   5474 
   5475    Note that `--stub-group-size' does not split input sections.  A
   5476 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
   5477 create a larger group (of one section).  If input sections are too
   5478 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
   5479 
   5480 
   5481 File: ld.info,  Node: M68K,  Next: MIPS,  Prev: HPPA ELF32,  Up: Machine Dependent
   5482 
   5483 4.6 `ld' and the Motorola 68K family
   5484 ====================================
   5485 
   5486 The `--got=TYPE' option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.  The
   5487 choices are `single', `negative', `multigot' and `target'.  When
   5488 `target' is selected the linker chooses the default GOT generation
   5489 scheme for the current target.  `single' tells the linker to generate a
   5490 single GOT with entries only at non-negative offsets.  `negative'
   5491 instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with entries at both
   5492 negative and positive offsets.  Not all environments support such GOTs.
   5493 `multigot' allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the output
   5494 file.  All GOT references from a single input object file access the
   5495 same GOT, but references from different input object files might access
   5496 different GOTs.  Not all environments support such GOTs.
   5497 
   5498 
   5499 File: ld.info,  Node: MIPS,  Next: MMIX,  Prev: M68K,  Up: Machine Dependent
   5500 
   5501 4.7 `ld' and the MIPS family
   5502 ============================
   5503 
   5504 The `--insn32' and `--no-insn32' options control the choice of
   5505 microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as
   5506 that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation.  If `--insn32'
   5507 is used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings.  By
   5508 default or if `--no-insn32' is used, all instruction encodings are used,
   5509 including 16-bit ones where possible.
   5510 
   5511 
   5512 File: ld.info,  Node: MMIX,  Next: MSP430,  Prev: MIPS,  Up: Machine Dependent
   5513 
   5514 4.8 `ld' and MMIX
   5515 =================
   5516 
   5517 For MMIX, there is a choice of generating `ELF' object files or `mmo'
   5518 object files when linking.  The simulator `mmix' understands the `mmo'
   5519 format.  The binutils `objcopy' utility can translate between the two
   5520 formats.
   5521 
   5522    There is one special section, the `.MMIX.reg_contents' section.
   5523 Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
   5524 registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special
   5525 symbols, equal to registers.  In a final link, the start address of the
   5526 `.MMIX.reg_contents' section corresponds to the first allocated global
   5527 register multiplied by 8.  Register `$255' is not included in this
   5528 section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the symbol
   5529 `Main' for `mmo' files.
   5530 
   5531    Global symbols with the prefix `__.MMIX.start.', for example
   5532 `__.MMIX.start..text' and `__.MMIX.start..data' are special.  The
   5533 default linker script uses these to set the default start address of a
   5534 section.
   5535 
   5536    Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a
   5537 section, are left out from an mmo file.
   5538 
   5539 
   5540 File: ld.info,  Node: MSP430,  Next: NDS32,  Prev: MMIX,  Up: Machine Dependent
   5541 
   5542 4.9 `ld' and MSP430
   5543 ===================
   5544 
   5545 For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture.  The flag
   5546 `-m [mpu type]' will select an appropriate linker script for selected
   5547 MPU type.  (To get a list of known MPUs just pass `-m help' option to
   5548 the linker).
   5549 
   5550    The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430
   5551 specific:
   5552 
   5553 ``.vectors''
   5554      Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
   5555 
   5556 ``.bootloader''
   5557      Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable).  Any
   5558      code in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
   5559 
   5560 ``.infomem''
   5561      Defines an information memory section (if applicable).  Any code in
   5562      this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
   5563 
   5564 ``.infomemnobits''
   5565      This is the same as the `.infomem' section except that any code in
   5566      this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
   5567 
   5568 ``.noinit''
   5569      Denotes a portion of RAM located above `.bss' section.
   5570 
   5571      The last two sections are used by gcc.
   5572 
   5573 
   5574 File: ld.info,  Node: NDS32,  Next: Nios II,  Prev: MSP430,  Up: Machine Dependent
   5575 
   5576 4.10 `ld' and NDS32
   5577 ===================
   5578 
   5579 For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior.  The
   5580 linker relaxes objects according to these options.
   5581 
   5582 ``--m[no-]fp-as-gp''
   5583      Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
   5584 
   5585 ``--mexport-symbols=FILE''
   5586      Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
   5587 
   5588 ``--m[no-]ex9''
   5589      Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
   5590 
   5591 ``--mexport-ex9=FILE''
   5592      Export the EX9 table after linking.
   5593 
   5594 ``--mimport-ex9=FILE''
   5595      Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
   5596 
   5597 ``--mupdate-ex9''
   5598      Update the existing EX9 table.
   5599 
   5600 ``--mex9-limit=NUM''
   5601      Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
   5602 
   5603 ``--mex9-loop-aware''
   5604      Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
   5605 
   5606 ``--m[no-]ifc''
   5607      Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
   5608 
   5609 ``--mifc-loop-aware''
   5610      Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
   5611 
   5612 
   5613 File: ld.info,  Node: Nios II,  Next: PowerPC ELF32,  Prev: NDS32,  Up: Machine Dependent
   5614 
   5615 4.11 `ld' and the Altera Nios II
   5616 ================================
   5617 
   5618 Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited
   5619 to transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
   5620 which may result in `ld' giving `relocation truncated to fit' errors
   5621 with very large programs.  The command-line option `--relax' enables
   5622 the generation of trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address
   5623 space for calls outside the normal `call' and `jmpi' address range.
   5624 These trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not
   5625 themselves be reachable if an input section and its associated call
   5626 trampolines are larger than 256MB.
   5627 
   5628    The `--relax' option is enabled by default unless `-r' is also
   5629 specified.  You can disable trampoline generation by using the
   5630 `--no-relax' linker option.  You can also disable this optimization
   5631 locally by using the `set .noat' directive in assembly-language source
   5632 files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the `at' register as a
   5633 temporary.
   5634 
   5635    Note that the linker `--relax' option is independent of assembler
   5636 relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's `-relax-all'
   5637 option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction
   5638 relaxation.
   5639 
   5640 
   5641 File: ld.info,  Node: PowerPC ELF32,  Next: PowerPC64 ELF64,  Prev: Nios II,  Up: Machine Dependent
   5642 
   5643 4.12 `ld' and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
   5644 ========================================
   5645 
   5646 Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
   5647 displacement, which may result in `ld' giving `relocation truncated to
   5648 fit' errors with very large programs.  `--relax' enables the generation
   5649 of trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space.  These
   5650 trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
   5651 be reachable if an input section exceeds 33M in size.  You may combine
   5652 `-r' and `--relax' to add trampolines in a partial link.  In that case
   5653 both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
   5654 considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
   5655 
   5656 `--bss-plt'
   5657      Current PowerPC GCC accepts a `-msecure-plt' option that generates
   5658      code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has the
   5659      security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
   5660      writable and no writable section ever being executable.  PowerPC
   5661      `ld' will generate this layout, including stubs to access the PLT,
   5662      if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
   5663      compiled with `-msecure-plt'.  `--bss-plt' forces the old BSS PLT
   5664      (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
   5665 
   5666 `--secure-plt'
   5667      `ld' will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
   5668      `-fpic' or `-fPIC' code, but does not do so automatically when
   5669      linking non-PIC code.  This option requests the new PLT and GOT
   5670      layout.  A warning will be given if some object file requires the
   5671      old style BSS PLT.
   5672 
   5673 `--sdata-got'
   5674      The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
   5675      sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement.  The
   5676      location of `.plt' must change because the new secure PLT is an
   5677      initialized section while the old PLT is uninitialized.  The
   5678      reason for the `.got' change is more subtle:  The new placement
   5679      allows `.got' to be read-only in applications linked with `-z
   5680      relro -z now'.  However, this placement means that `.sdata' cannot
   5681      always be used in shared libraries, because the PowerPC ABI
   5682      accesses `.sdata' in shared libraries from the GOT pointer.
   5683      `--sdata-got' forces the old GOT placement.  PowerPC GCC doesn't
   5684      use `.sdata' in shared libraries, so this option is really only
   5685      useful for other compilers that may do so.
   5686 
   5687 `--emit-stub-syms'
   5688      This option causes `ld' to label linker stubs with a local symbol
   5689      that encodes the stub type and destination.
   5690 
   5691 `--no-tls-optimize'
   5692      PowerPC `ld' normally performs some optimization of code sequences
   5693      used to access Thread-Local Storage.  Use this option to disable
   5694      the optimization.
   5695 
   5696 
   5697 File: ld.info,  Node: PowerPC64 ELF64,  Next: SPU ELF,  Prev: PowerPC ELF32,  Up: Machine Dependent
   5698 
   5699 4.13 `ld' and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
   5700 ==========================================
   5701 
   5702 `--stub-group-size'
   5703      Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs  and TOC adjusting stubs are
   5704      placed by `ld' in stub sections located between groups of input
   5705      sections.  `--stub-group-size' specifies the maximum size of a
   5706      group of input sections handled by one stub section.  Since branch
   5707      offsets are signed, a stub section may serve two groups of input
   5708      sections, one group before the stub section, and one group after
   5709      it.  However, when using conditional branches that require stubs,
   5710      it may be better (for branch prediction) that stub sections only
   5711      serve one group of input sections.  A negative value for `N'
   5712      chooses this scheme, ensuring that branches to stubs always use a
   5713      negative offset.  Two special values of `N' are recognized, `1'
   5714      and `-1'.  These both instruct `ld' to automatically size input
   5715      section groups for the branch types detected, with the same
   5716      behaviour regarding stub placement as other positive or negative
   5717      values of `N' respectively.
   5718 
   5719      Note that `--stub-group-size' does not split input sections.  A
   5720      single input section larger than the group size specified will of
   5721      course create a larger group (of one section).  If input sections
   5722      are too large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its
   5723      stub.
   5724 
   5725 `--emit-stub-syms'
   5726      This option causes `ld' to label linker stubs with a local symbol
   5727      that encodes the stub type and destination.
   5728 
   5729 `--dotsyms, --no-dotsyms'
   5730      These two options control how `ld' interprets version patterns in
   5731      a version script.  Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
   5732      function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and
   5733      a code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (`.').  To
   5734      properly version a function `foo', the version script thus needs
   5735      to control both `foo' and `.foo'.  The option `--dotsyms', on by
   5736      default, automatically adds the required dot-prefixed patterns.
   5737      Use `--no-dotsyms' to disable this feature.
   5738 
   5739 `--no-tls-optimize'
   5740      PowerPC64 `ld' normally performs some optimization of code
   5741      sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage.  Use this option to
   5742      disable the optimization.
   5743 
   5744 `--no-opd-optimize'
   5745      PowerPC64 `ld' normally removes `.opd' section entries
   5746      corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed
   5747      by the action of `--gc-sections' or linker script `/DISCARD/'.
   5748      Use this option to disable `.opd' optimization.
   5749 
   5750 `--non-overlapping-opd'
   5751      Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
   5752      `.opd' entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
   5753      the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the
   5754      next entry.  This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
   5755 
   5756 `--no-toc-optimize'
   5757      PowerPC64 `ld' normally removes unused `.toc' section entries.
   5758      Such entries are detected by examining relocations that reference
   5759      the TOC in code sections.  A reloc in a deleted code section marks
   5760      a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section marks
   5761      a TOC word as needed.  Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
   5762      relocs are also examined.  TOC words marked as both needed and
   5763      unneeded will of course be kept.  TOC words without any referencing
   5764      reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
   5765      discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word.  This works
   5766      reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if
   5767      assembly code is used to insert TOC entries.  Use this option to
   5768      disable the optimization.
   5769 
   5770 `--no-multi-toc'
   5771      If given any toc option besides `-mcmodel=medium' or
   5772      `-mcmodel=large', PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
   5773      where TOC entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2.  This
   5774      limits the total TOC size to 64K.  PowerPC64 `ld' extends this
   5775      limit by grouping code sections such that each group uses less
   5776      than 64K for its TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs
   5777      between inter-group calls.  `ld' does not split apart input
   5778      sections, so cannot help if a single input file has a `.toc'
   5779      section that exceeds 64K, most likely from linking multiple files
   5780      with `ld -r'.  Use this option to turn off this feature.
   5781 
   5782 `--no-toc-sort'
   5783      By default, `ld' sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
   5784      happens to have a section called `.init' or `.fini' are placed
   5785      first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated with
   5786      PowerPC64 gcc's `-mcmodel=small', and lastly TOC sections
   5787      referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
   5788      `-mcmodel=medium' or `-mcmodel=large' options.  Doing this results
   5789      in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC.  Use this option to turn off
   5790      this feature.
   5791 
   5792 `--plt-align'
   5793 `--no-plt-align'
   5794      Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
   5795      padded so that they don't cross a 32-byte boundary, or to the
   5796      specified power of two boundary when using `--plt-align='.  Note
   5797      that this isn't alignment in the usual sense.  By default PLT call
   5798      stubs are packed tightly.
   5799 
   5800 `--plt-static-chain'
   5801 `--no-plt-static-chain'
   5802      Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
   5803      chain pointer (r11).  `ld' defaults to not loading the static
   5804      chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
   5805 
   5806 `--plt-thread-safe'
   5807 `--no-thread-safe'
   5808      With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when
   5809      using lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread
   5810      and have another thread see the individual plt entry words update
   5811      in the wrong order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct
   5812      order and using memory write barriers.  To avoid this we need some
   5813      sort of read barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1.  By
   5814      default, `ld' looks for calls to commonly used functions that
   5815      create threads, and if seen, adds the necessary barriers.  Use
   5816      these options to change the default behaviour.
   5817 
   5818 
   5819 File: ld.info,  Node: SPU ELF,  Next: TI COFF,  Prev: PowerPC64 ELF64,  Up: Machine Dependent
   5820 
   5821 4.14 `ld' and SPU ELF Support
   5822 =============================
   5823 
   5824 `--plugin'
   5825      This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
   5826 
   5827 `--no-overlays'
   5828      Normally, `ld' recognizes calls to functions within overlay
   5829      regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
   5830      `ld' also provides a built-in overlay manager.  This option turns
   5831      off all this special overlay handling.
   5832 
   5833 `--emit-stub-syms'
   5834      This option causes `ld' to label overlay stubs with a local symbol
   5835      that encodes the stub type and destination.
   5836 
   5837 `--extra-overlay-stubs'
   5838      This option causes `ld' to add overlay call stubs on all function
   5839      calls out of overlay regions.  Normally stubs are not added on
   5840      calls to non-overlay regions.
   5841 
   5842 `--local-store=lo:hi'
   5843      `ld' usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in the
   5844      address range 0 to 256k.  This option may be used to change the
   5845      range.  Disable the check entirely with `--local-store=0:0'.
   5846 
   5847 `--stack-analysis'
   5848      SPU local store space is limited.  Over-allocation of stack space
   5849      unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
   5850      under-allocation results in runtime failures.  If given this
   5851      option, `ld' will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
   5852      `ld' does this by examining symbols in code sections to determine
   5853      the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues for
   5854      stack adjusting instructions.  A call-graph is created by looking
   5855      for relocations on branch instructions.  The graph is then searched
   5856      for the maximum stack usage path.  Note that this analysis does not
   5857      find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle
   5858      recursion and other cycles in the call graph.  Stack usage may be
   5859      under-estimated if your code makes such calls.  Also, stack usage
   5860      for dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected.  If a
   5861      link map is requested, detailed information about each function's
   5862      stack usage and calls will be given.
   5863 
   5864 `--emit-stack-syms'
   5865      This option, if given along with `--stack-analysis' will result in
   5866      `ld' emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.  These take
   5867      the form `__stack_<function_name>' for global functions, and
   5868      `__stack_<number>_<function_name>' for static functions.
   5869      `<number>' is the section id in hex.  The value of such symbols is
   5870      the stack requirement for the corresponding function.  The symbol
   5871      size will be zero, type `STT_NOTYPE', binding `STB_LOCAL', and
   5872      section `SHN_ABS'.
   5873 
   5874 
   5875 File: ld.info,  Node: TI COFF,  Next: WIN32,  Prev: SPU ELF,  Up: Machine Dependent
   5876 
   5877 4.15 `ld''s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
   5878 ================================================
   5879 
   5880 The `--format' switch allows selection of one of the various TI COFF
   5881 versions.  The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are also
   5882 supported.  The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order format;
   5883 `ld' will read any version or byte order, but the output header format
   5884 depends on the default specified by the specific target.
   5885 
   5886 
   5887 File: ld.info,  Node: WIN32,  Next: Xtensa,  Prev: TI COFF,  Up: Machine Dependent
   5888 
   5889 4.16 `ld' and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
   5890 ==================================
   5891 
   5892 This section describes some of the win32 specific `ld' issues.  See
   5893 *Note Command Line Options: Options. for detailed description of the
   5894 command line options mentioned here.
   5895 
   5896 _import libraries_
   5897      The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
   5898      libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's.  They
   5899      are regular static archives and are handled as any other static
   5900      archive.  The cygwin and mingw ports of `ld' have specific support
   5901      for creating such libraries provided with the `--out-implib'
   5902      command line option.
   5903 
   5904 _exporting DLL symbols_
   5905      The cygwin/mingw `ld' has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
   5906 
   5907     _using auto-export functionality_
   5908           By default `ld' exports symbols with the auto-export
   5909           functionality, which is controlled by the following command
   5910           line options:
   5911 
   5912              * -export-all-symbols   [This is the default]
   5913 
   5914              * -exclude-symbols
   5915 
   5916              * -exclude-libs
   5917 
   5918              * -exclude-modules-for-implib
   5919 
   5920              * -version-script
   5921 
   5922           When auto-export is in operation, `ld' will export all the
   5923           non-local (global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with
   5924           the exception of a few symbols known to belong to the
   5925           system's runtime and libraries.  As it will often not be
   5926           desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
   5927           private functions that are not part of any public interface,
   5928           the command-line options listed above may be used to filter
   5929           symbols out from the list for exporting.  The `--output-def'
   5930           option can be used in order to see the final list of exported
   5931           symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
   5932 
   5933           If `--export-all-symbols' is not given explicitly on the
   5934           command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be
   5935           _disabled_ if either of the following are true:
   5936 
   5937              * A DEF file is used.
   5938 
   5939              * Any symbol in any object file was marked with the
   5940                __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
   5941 
   5942     _using a DEF file_
   5943           Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file.  A DEF
   5944           file is an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which
   5945           should be exported when a dll is created.  Usually it is
   5946           named `<dll name>.def' and is added as any other object file
   5947           to the linker's command line.  The file's name must end in
   5948           `.def' or `.DEF'.
   5949 
   5950                gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
   5951 
   5952           Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior,
   5953           unless the `--export-all-symbols' option is also used.
   5954 
   5955           Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called
   5956           `xyz.dll':
   5957 
   5958                LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
   5959 
   5960                EXPORTS
   5961                foo
   5962                bar
   5963                _bar = bar
   5964                another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
   5965                var1 DATA
   5966                doo = foo == foo2
   5967                eoo DATA == var1
   5968 
   5969           This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address
   5970           and seven symbols in the export table. The third exported
   5971           symbol `_bar' is an alias for the second. The fourth symbol,
   5972           `another_foo' is resolved by "forwarding" to another module
   5973           and treating it as an alias for `afoo' exported from the DLL
   5974           `abc.dll'. The final symbol `var1' is declared to be a data
   5975           object. The `doo' symbol in export library is an alias of
   5976           `foo', which gets the string name in export table `foo2'. The
   5977           `eoo' symbol is an data export symbol, which gets in export
   5978           table the name `var1'.
   5979 
   5980           The optional `LIBRARY <name>' command indicates the _internal_
   5981           name of the output DLL. If `<name>' does not include a suffix,
   5982           the default library suffix, `.DLL' is appended.
   5983 
   5984           When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather
   5985           than a library, the `NAME <name>' command should be used
   5986           instead of `LIBRARY'. If `<name>' does not include a suffix,
   5987           the default executable suffix, `.EXE' is appended.
   5988 
   5989           With either `LIBRARY <name>' or `NAME <name>' the optional
   5990           specification `BASE = <number>' may be used to specify a
   5991           non-default base address for the image.
   5992 
   5993           If neither `LIBRARY <name>' nor  `NAME <name>' is specified,
   5994           or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the
   5995           same as the filename specified on the command line.
   5996 
   5997           The complete specification of an export symbol is:
   5998 
   5999                EXPORTS
   6000                  ( (  ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
   6001                     | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
   6002                  [ @ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
   6003 
   6004           Declares `<name1>' as an exported symbol from the DLL, or
   6005           declares `<name1>' as an exported alias for `<name2>'; or
   6006           declares `<name1>' as a "forward" alias for the symbol
   6007           `<external-name>' in the DLL `<module-name>'.  Optionally,
   6008           the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
   6009           `<integer>' alias. The optional `<name3>' is the to be used
   6010           string in import/export table for the symbol.
   6011 
   6012           The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
   6013 
   6014           `NONAME': Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export
   6015           table.  It will still be exported by its ordinal alias
   6016           (either the value specified by the .def specification or,
   6017           otherwise, the value assigned by the linker). The symbol
   6018           name, however, does remain visible in the import library (if
   6019           any), unless `PRIVATE' is also specified.
   6020 
   6021           `DATA': The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a
   6022           function.  The import lib will export only an indirect
   6023           reference to `foo' as the symbol `_imp__foo' (ie, `foo' must
   6024           be resolved as `*_imp__foo').
   6025 
   6026           `CONSTANT': Like `DATA', but put the undecorated `foo' as
   6027           well as `_imp__foo' into the import library. Both refer to the
   6028           read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not
   6029           to the variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user
   6030           code fails to add the `dllimport' attribute and also fails to
   6031           explicitly add the extra indirection that the use of the
   6032           attribute enforces, the application will behave unexpectedly.
   6033 
   6034           `PRIVATE': Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do
   6035           not put it into the static import library used to resolve
   6036           imports at link time. The symbol can still be imported using
   6037           the `LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress' API at runtime or by by
   6038           using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to the DLL
   6039           without an import library.
   6040 
   6041           See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full
   6042           specification of other DEF file statements
   6043 
   6044           While linking a shared dll, `ld' is able to create a DEF file
   6045           with the `--output-def <file>' command line option.
   6046 
   6047     _Using decorations_
   6048           Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the
   6049           source code itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol
   6050           to be exported is declared as:
   6051 
   6052                __declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
   6053                __declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
   6054 
   6055           All such symbols will be exported from the DLL.  If, however,
   6056           any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated
   6057           in this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is
   6058           disabled, unless the `--export-all-symbols' option is also
   6059           used.
   6060 
   6061           Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must
   6062           _not_ decorate them with dllexport.  Instead, they should use
   6063           dllimport, instead:
   6064 
   6065                __declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
   6066                __declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
   6067 
   6068           This complicates the structure of library header files,
   6069           because when included by the library itself the header must
   6070           declare the variables and functions as dllexport, but when
   6071           included by client code the header must declare them as
   6072           dllimport.  There are a number of idioms that are typically
   6073           used to do this; often client code can omit the __declspec()
   6074           declaration completely.  See `--enable-auto-import' and
   6075           `automatic data imports' for more information.
   6076 
   6077 _automatic data imports_
   6078      The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls
   6079      only by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which
   6080      let the compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal
   6081      with this issue.  This increases the effort necessary to port
   6082      existing Un*x code to these platforms, especially for large c++
   6083      libraries and applications.  The auto-import feature, which was
   6084      initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
   6085      decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on
   6086      POSIX/Un*x platforms. This feature is enabled with the
   6087      `--enable-auto-import' command-line option, although it is enabled
   6088      by default on cygwin/mingw.  The `--enable-auto-import' option
   6089      itself now serves mainly to suppress any warnings that are
   6090      ordinarily emitted when linked objects trigger the feature's use.
   6091 
   6092      auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
   6093      additional assistance.  Sometimes, you will see this message
   6094 
   6095      "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
   6096      documentation for ld's `--enable-auto-import' for details."
   6097 
   6098      The `--enable-auto-import' documentation explains why this error
   6099      occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this
   6100      difficulty.  One of these methods is the _runtime pseudo-relocs_
   6101      feature, described below.
   6102 
   6103      For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or
   6104      classes), object files typically contain a base address for the
   6105      variable and an offset (_addend_) within the variable-to specify a
   6106      particular field or public member, for instance.  Unfortunately,
   6107      the runtime loader used in win32 environments is incapable of
   6108      fixing these references at runtime without the additional
   6109      information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.  The
   6110      standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve
   6111      these references.
   6112 
   6113      The `--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs' switch allows these
   6114      references to be resolved without error, while leaving the task of
   6115      adjusting the references themselves (with their non-zero addends)
   6116      to specialized code provided by the runtime environment.  Recent
   6117      versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and compilers
   6118      provide this runtime support; older versions do not.  However, the
   6119      support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the
   6120      compiled result will run without error on an older system.
   6121 
   6122      `--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs' is not the default; it must be
   6123      explicitly enabled as needed.
   6124 
   6125 _direct linking to a dll_
   6126      The cygwin/mingw ports of `ld' support the direct linking,
   6127      including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
   6128      libraries.  This is much faster and uses much less memory than
   6129      does the traditional import library method, especially when
   6130      linking large libraries or applications.  When `ld' creates an
   6131      import lib, each function or variable exported from the dll is
   6132      stored in its own bfd, even though a single bfd could contain many
   6133      exports.  The overhead involved in storing, loading, and
   6134      processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
   6135      tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against
   6136      particularly large or complex libraries when using import libs.
   6137 
   6138      Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches
   6139      other than `-L' and `-l', because `ld' already searches for a
   6140      number of names to match each library.  All that is needed from
   6141      the developer's perspective is an understanding of this search, in
   6142      order to force ld to select the dll instead of an import library.
   6143 
   6144      For instance, when ld is called with the argument `-lxxx' it will
   6145      attempt to find, in the first directory of its search path,
   6146 
   6147           libxxx.dll.a
   6148           xxx.dll.a
   6149           libxxx.a
   6150           xxx.lib
   6151           cygxxx.dll (*)
   6152           libxxx.dll
   6153           xxx.dll
   6154 
   6155      before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
   6156 
   6157      (*) Actually, this is not `cygxxx.dll' but in fact is
   6158      `<prefix>xxx.dll', where `<prefix>' is set by the `ld' option
   6159      `--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>'. In the case of cygwin, the
   6160      standard gcc spec file includes `--dll-search-prefix=cyg', so in
   6161      effect we actually search for `cygxxx.dll'.
   6162 
   6163      Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may
   6164      use other `<prefix>'es, although at present only cygwin makes use
   6165      of this feature.  It was originally intended to help avoid name
   6166      conflicts among dll's built for the various win32/un*x
   6167      environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
   6168      could coexist on the same machine.
   6169 
   6170      The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a `bin' directory for
   6171      applications and dll's and a `lib' directory for the import
   6172      libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
   6173 
   6174           bin/
   6175           	cygxxx.dll
   6176           lib/
   6177           	libxxx.dll.a   (in case of dll's)
   6178           	libxxx.a       (in case of static archive)
   6179 
   6180      Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
   6181      done two ways:
   6182 
   6183      1. Use the dll directly by adding the `bin' path to the link line
   6184           gcc -Wl,-verbose  -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
   6185 
   6186      However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their
   6187      names (`cygncurses-5.dll') this will often fail, unless one
   6188      specifies `-L../bin -lncurses-5' to include the version.  Import
   6189      libs are generally not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
   6190 
   6191      2. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the `lib'
   6192      directory according to the above mentioned search pattern.  This
   6193      should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
   6194      making the app/dll.
   6195 
   6196           ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
   6197 
   6198      Then you can link without any make environment changes.
   6199 
   6200           gcc -Wl,-verbose  -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
   6201 
   6202      This technique also avoids the version number problems, because
   6203      the following is perfectly legal
   6204 
   6205           bin/
   6206           	cygxxx-5.dll
   6207           lib/
   6208           	libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
   6209 
   6210      Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
   6211      even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
   6212      `--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs' is used.
   6213 
   6214      Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might
   6215      justifiably wonder why import libraries are used at all.  There
   6216      are three reasons:
   6217 
   6218      1. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did _not_
   6219      work with auto-imported data.
   6220 
   6221      2. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within
   6222      the import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for
   6223      indirection symbols that point to the exports of a dll).  Again,
   6224      the import lib for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability,
   6225      and it is not possible to do this without an import lib.
   6226 
   6227      3. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib.  This
   6228      is critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32
   6229      API) in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases
   6230      of their stdcall-decorated assembly names.
   6231 
   6232      So, import libs are not going away.  But the ability to replace
   6233      true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of) a
   6234      dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
   6235      binutils makes available to the win32 developer.  Given the
   6236      massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
   6237      requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
   6238      will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
   6239 
   6240 _symbol aliasing_
   6241 
   6242     _adding additional names_
   6243           Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional
   6244           names.  A symbol `foo' will be exported as `foo', but it can
   6245           also be exported as `_foo' by using special directives in the
   6246           DEF file when creating the dll.  This will affect also the
   6247           optional created import library.  Consider the following DEF
   6248           file:
   6249 
   6250                LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
   6251 
   6252                EXPORTS
   6253                foo
   6254                _foo = foo
   6255 
   6256           The line `_foo = foo' maps the symbol `foo' to `_foo'.
   6257 
   6258           Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in
   6259           the source code using the "weak" attribute:
   6260 
   6261                void foo () { /* Do something.  */; }
   6262                void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
   6263 
   6264           See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and
   6265           weak symbols.
   6266 
   6267     _renaming symbols_
   6268           Sometimes it is useful to rename exports.  For instance, the
   6269           cygwin kernel does this regularly.  A symbol `_foo' can be
   6270           exported as `foo' but not as `_foo' by using special
   6271           directives in the DEF file. (This will also affect the import
   6272           library, if it is created).  In the following example:
   6273 
   6274                LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
   6275 
   6276                EXPORTS
   6277                _foo = foo
   6278 
   6279           The line `_foo = foo' maps the exported symbol `foo' to
   6280           `_foo'.
   6281 
   6282      Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
   6283      unless the `--export-all-symbols' command line option is used.
   6284      If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
   6285      _all_ desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols that
   6286      are not being renamed, and do _not_ use the `--export-all-symbols'
   6287      option.  If you list only the renamed symbols in the DEF file, and
   6288      use `--export-all-symbols' to handle the other symbols, then the
   6289      both the new names _and_ the original names for the renamed
   6290      symbols will be exported.  In effect, you'd be aliasing those
   6291      symbols, not renaming them, which is probably not what you wanted.
   6292 
   6293 _weak externals_
   6294      The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols
   6295      called weak externals.  When a weak symbol is linked and the
   6296      symbol is not defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some
   6297      other symbol.  There are three variants of weak externals:
   6298         * Definition is searched for in objects and libraries,
   6299           historically called lazy externals.
   6300 
   6301         * Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in
   6302           libraries.  This form is not presently implemented.
   6303 
   6304         * No search; the symbol is an alias.  This form is not presently
   6305           implemented.
   6306      As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate
   6307      symbol are supported.  If the symbol is undefined when linking,
   6308      the symbol uses a default value.
   6309 
   6310 _aligned common symbols_
   6311      As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to
   6312      specify the desired alignment for a common symbol.  This
   6313      information is conveyed from the assembler or compiler to the
   6314      linker by means of GNU-specific commands carried in the object
   6315      file's `.drectve' section, which are recognized by `ld' and
   6316      respected when laying out the common symbols.  Native tools will
   6317      be able to process object files employing this GNU extension, but
   6318      will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue
   6319      noisy warnings about unknown linker directives.
   6320 
   6321 
   6322 
   6323 File: ld.info,  Node: Xtensa,  Prev: WIN32,  Up: Machine Dependent
   6324 
   6325 4.17 `ld' and Xtensa Processors
   6326 ===============================
   6327 
   6328 The default `ld' behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
   6329 `SECTIONS' commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
   6330 specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
   6331 keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets.  For
   6332 example, with the command:
   6333 
   6334      SECTIONS
   6335      {
   6336        .text : {
   6337          *(.literal .text)
   6338        }
   6339      }
   6340 
   6341 `ld' may interleave some of the `.literal' and `.text' sections from
   6342 different object files to ensure that the literal pools are within the
   6343 range of PC-relative load offsets.  A valid interleaving might place
   6344 the `.literal' sections from an initial group of files followed by the
   6345 `.text' sections of that group of files.  Then, the `.literal' sections
   6346 from the rest of the files and the `.text' sections from the rest of
   6347 the files would follow.
   6348 
   6349    Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of `ld' and
   6350 provides two important link-time optimizations.  The first optimization
   6351 is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size.  A redundant
   6352 literal will be removed and all the `L32R' instructions that use it
   6353 will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
   6354 location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
   6355 the `L32R' instructions.  The second optimization is to remove
   6356 unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated "longcall" sequences of
   6357 `L32R'/`CALLXN' when the target functions are within range of direct
   6358 `CALLN' instructions.
   6359 
   6360    For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be
   6361 optimized to a direct call, the linker will change the `CALLXN'
   6362 instruction to a `CALLN' instruction, remove the `L32R' instruction,
   6363 and remove the literal referenced by the `L32R' instruction if it is
   6364 not used for anything else.  Removing the `L32R' instruction always
   6365 reduces code size but can potentially hurt performance by changing the
   6366 alignment of subsequent branch targets.  By default, the linker will
   6367 always preserve alignments, either by switching some instructions
   6368 between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent density instructions or by
   6369 inserting a no-op in place of the `L32R' instruction that was removed.
   6370 If code size is more important than performance, the `--size-opt'
   6371 option can be used to prevent the linker from widening density
   6372 instructions or inserting no-ops, except in a few cases where no-ops
   6373 are required for correctness.
   6374 
   6375    The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
   6376 control the linker:
   6377 
   6378 `--size-opt'
   6379      When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code
   6380      size more than performance.  With this option, the linker will not
   6381      insert no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch
   6382      target alignment.  There may still be some cases where no-ops are
   6383      required to preserve the correctness of the code.
   6384 
   6385 
   6386 File: ld.info,  Node: BFD,  Next: Reporting Bugs,  Prev: Machine Dependent,  Up: Top
   6387 
   6388 5 BFD
   6389 *****
   6390 
   6391 The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
   6392 These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
   6393 object files whatever the object file format.  A different object file
   6394 format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
   6395 it to the library.  To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
   6396 associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
   6397 object file formats available.  You can use `objdump -i' (*note
   6398 objdump: (binutils.info)objdump.) to list all the formats available for
   6399 your configuration.
   6400 
   6401    As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between several
   6402 conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing BFD design was
   6403 efficiency: any time used converting between formats is time which
   6404 would not have been spent had BFD not been involved. This is partly
   6405 offset by abstraction payback; since BFD simplifies applications and
   6406 back ends, more time and care may be spent optimizing algorithms for a
   6407 greater speed.
   6408 
   6409    One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in mind
   6410 is the potential for information loss.  There are two places where
   6411 useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
   6412 conversion and during output. *Note BFD information loss::.
   6413 
   6414 * Menu:
   6415 
   6416 * BFD outline::                 How it works: an outline of BFD
   6417 
   6418 
   6419 File: ld.info,  Node: BFD outline,  Up: BFD
   6420 
   6421 5.1 How It Works: An Outline of BFD
   6422 ===================================
   6423 
   6424 When an object file is opened, BFD subroutines automatically determine
   6425 the format of the input object file.  They then build a descriptor in
   6426 memory with pointers to routines that will be used to access elements of
   6427 the object file's data structures.
   6428 
   6429    As different information from the object files is required, BFD
   6430 reads from different sections of the file and processes them.  For
   6431 example, a very common operation for the linker is processing symbol
   6432 tables.  Each BFD back end provides a routine for converting between
   6433 the object file's representation of symbols and an internal canonical
   6434 format. When the linker asks for the symbol table of an object file, it
   6435 calls through a memory pointer to the routine from the relevant BFD
   6436 back end which reads and converts the table into a canonical form.  The
   6437 linker then operates upon the canonical form. When the link is finished
   6438 and the linker writes the output file's symbol table, another BFD back
   6439 end routine is called to take the newly created symbol table and
   6440 convert it into the chosen output format.
   6441 
   6442 * Menu:
   6443 
   6444 * BFD information loss::	Information Loss
   6445 * Canonical format::		The BFD	canonical object-file format
   6446 
   6447 
   6448 File: ld.info,  Node: BFD information loss,  Next: Canonical format,  Up: BFD outline
   6449 
   6450 5.1.1 Information Loss
   6451 ----------------------
   6452 
   6453 _Information can be lost during output._ The output formats supported
   6454 by BFD do not provide identical facilities, and information which can
   6455 be described in one form has nowhere to go in another format. One
   6456 example of this is alignment information in `b.out'. There is nowhere
   6457 in an `a.out' format file to store alignment information on the
   6458 contained data, so when a file is linked from `b.out' and an `a.out'
   6459 image is produced, alignment information will not propagate to the
   6460 output file. (The linker will still use the alignment information
   6461 internally, so the link is performed correctly).
   6462 
   6463    Another example is COFF section names. COFF files may contain an
   6464 unlimited number of sections, each one with a textual section name. If
   6465 the target of the link is a format which does not have many sections
   6466 (e.g., `a.out') or has sections without names (e.g., the Oasys format),
   6467 the link cannot be done simply. You can circumvent this problem by
   6468 describing the desired input-to-output section mapping with the linker
   6469 command language.
   6470 
   6471    _Information can be lost during canonicalization._ The BFD internal
   6472 canonical form of the external formats is not exhaustive; there are
   6473 structures in input formats for which there is no direct representation
   6474 internally.  This means that the BFD back ends cannot maintain all
   6475 possible data richness through the transformation between external to
   6476 internal and back to external formats.
   6477 
   6478    This limitation is only a problem when an application reads one
   6479 format and writes another.  Each BFD back end is responsible for
   6480 maintaining as much data as possible, and the internal BFD canonical
   6481 form has structures which are opaque to the BFD core, and exported only
   6482 to the back ends. When a file is read in one format, the canonical form
   6483 is generated for BFD and the application. At the same time, the back
   6484 end saves away any information which may otherwise be lost. If the data
   6485 is then written back in the same format, the back end routine will be
   6486 able to use the canonical form provided by the BFD core as well as the
   6487 information it prepared earlier.  Since there is a great deal of
   6488 commonality between back ends, there is no information lost when
   6489 linking or copying big endian COFF to little endian COFF, or `a.out' to
   6490 `b.out'.  When a mixture of formats is linked, the information is only
   6491 lost from the files whose format differs from the destination.
   6492 
   6493 
   6494 File: ld.info,  Node: Canonical format,  Prev: BFD information loss,  Up: BFD outline
   6495 
   6496 5.1.2 The BFD canonical object-file format
   6497 ------------------------------------------
   6498 
   6499 The greatest potential for loss of information occurs when there is the
   6500 least overlap between the information provided by the source format,
   6501 that stored by the canonical format, and that needed by the destination
   6502 format. A brief description of the canonical form may help you
   6503 understand which kinds of data you can count on preserving across
   6504 conversions.  
   6505 
   6506 _files_
   6507      Information stored on a per-file basis includes target machine
   6508      architecture, particular implementation format type, a demand
   6509      pageable bit, and a write protected bit.  Information like Unix
   6510      magic numbers is not stored here--only the magic numbers' meaning,
   6511      so a `ZMAGIC' file would have both the demand pageable bit and the
   6512      write protected text bit set.  The byte order of the target is
   6513      stored on a per-file basis, so that big- and little-endian object
   6514      files may be used with one another.
   6515 
   6516 _sections_
   6517      Each section in the input file contains the name of the section,
   6518      the section's original address in the object file, size and
   6519      alignment information, various flags, and pointers into other BFD
   6520      data structures.
   6521 
   6522 _symbols_
   6523      Each symbol contains a pointer to the information for the object
   6524      file which originally defined it, its name, its value, and various
   6525      flag bits.  When a BFD back end reads in a symbol table, it
   6526      relocates all symbols to make them relative to the base of the
   6527      section where they were defined.  Doing this ensures that each
   6528      symbol points to its containing section.  Each symbol also has a
   6529      varying amount of hidden private data for the BFD back end.  Since
   6530      the symbol points to the original file, the private data format
   6531      for that symbol is accessible.  `ld' can operate on a collection
   6532      of symbols of wildly different formats without problems.
   6533 
   6534      Normal global and simple local symbols are maintained on output,
   6535      so an output file (no matter its format) will retain symbols
   6536      pointing to functions and to global, static, and common variables.
   6537      Some symbol information is not worth retaining; in `a.out', type
   6538      information is stored in the symbol table as long symbol names.
   6539      This information would be useless to most COFF debuggers; the
   6540      linker has command line switches to allow users to throw it away.
   6541 
   6542      There is one word of type information within the symbol, so if the
   6543      format supports symbol type information within symbols (for
   6544      example, COFF, IEEE, Oasys) and the type is simple enough to fit
   6545      within one word (nearly everything but aggregates), the
   6546      information will be preserved.
   6547 
   6548 _relocation level_
   6549      Each canonical BFD relocation record contains a pointer to the
   6550      symbol to relocate to, the offset of the data to relocate, the
   6551      section the data is in, and a pointer to a relocation type
   6552      descriptor. Relocation is performed by passing messages through
   6553      the relocation type descriptor and the symbol pointer. Therefore,
   6554      relocations can be performed on output data using a relocation
   6555      method that is only available in one of the input formats. For
   6556      instance, Oasys provides a byte relocation format.  A relocation
   6557      record requesting this relocation type would point indirectly to a
   6558      routine to perform this, so the relocation may be performed on a
   6559      byte being written to a 68k COFF file, even though 68k COFF has no
   6560      such relocation type.
   6561 
   6562 _line numbers_
   6563      Object formats can contain, for debugging purposes, some form of
   6564      mapping between symbols, source line numbers, and addresses in the
   6565      output file.  These addresses have to be relocated along with the
   6566      symbol information.  Each symbol with an associated list of line
   6567      number records points to the first record of the list.  The head
   6568      of a line number list consists of a pointer to the symbol, which
   6569      allows finding out the address of the function whose line number
   6570      is being described. The rest of the list is made up of pairs:
   6571      offsets into the section and line numbers. Any format which can
   6572      simply derive this information can pass it successfully between
   6573      formats (COFF, IEEE and Oasys).
   6574 
   6575 
   6576 File: ld.info,  Node: Reporting Bugs,  Next: MRI,  Prev: BFD,  Up: Top
   6577 
   6578 6 Reporting Bugs
   6579 ****************
   6580 
   6581 Your bug reports play an essential role in making `ld' reliable.
   6582 
   6583    Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem,
   6584 or it may not.  But in any case the principal function of a bug report
   6585 is to help the entire community by making the next version of `ld' work
   6586 better.  Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of `ld'.
   6587 
   6588    In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
   6589 information that enables us to fix the bug.
   6590 
   6591 * Menu:
   6592 
   6593 * Bug Criteria::                Have you found a bug?
   6594 * Bug Reporting::               How to report bugs
   6595 
   6596 
   6597 File: ld.info,  Node: Bug Criteria,  Next: Bug Reporting,  Up: Reporting Bugs
   6598 
   6599 6.1 Have You Found a Bug?
   6600 =========================
   6601 
   6602 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some
   6603 guidelines:
   6604 
   6605    * If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is
   6606      a `ld' bug.  Reliable linkers never crash.
   6607 
   6608    * If `ld' produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
   6609 
   6610    * If `ld' does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
   6611      may be a bug.  In the general case, the linker can not verify that
   6612      object files are correct.
   6613 
   6614    * If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
   6615      improvement of `ld' are welcome in any case.
   6616 
   6617 
   6618 File: ld.info,  Node: Bug Reporting,  Prev: Bug Criteria,  Up: Reporting Bugs
   6619 
   6620 6.2 How to Report Bugs
   6621 ======================
   6622 
   6623 A number of companies and individuals offer support for GNU products.
   6624 If you obtained `ld' from a support organization, we recommend you
   6625 contact that organization first.
   6626 
   6627    You can find contact information for many support companies and
   6628 individuals in the file `etc/SERVICE' in the GNU Emacs distribution.
   6629 
   6630    Otherwise, send bug reports for `ld' to
   6631 `http://www.sourceware.org/bugzilla/'.
   6632 
   6633    The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
   6634 *report all the facts*.  If you are not sure whether to state a fact or
   6635 leave it out, state it!
   6636 
   6637    Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
   6638 problem and assume that some details do not matter.  Thus, you might
   6639 assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not matter.
   6640 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure.  Perhaps the bug
   6641 is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location
   6642 where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were
   6643 different, the contents of that location would fool the linker into
   6644 doing the right thing despite the bug.  Play it safe and give a
   6645 specific, complete example.  That is the easiest thing for you to do,
   6646 and the most helpful.
   6647 
   6648    Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
   6649 the bug if it is new to us.  Therefore, always write your bug reports
   6650 on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
   6651 
   6652    Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, "Does this ring a
   6653 bell?"  This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless.  We
   6654 respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.  You
   6655 might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
   6656 
   6657    To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
   6658 
   6659    * The version of `ld'.  `ld' announces it if you start it with the
   6660      `--version' argument.
   6661 
   6662      Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in
   6663      looking for the bug in the current version of `ld'.
   6664 
   6665    * Any patches you may have applied to the `ld' source, including any
   6666      patches made to the `BFD' library.
   6667 
   6668    * The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name
   6669      and version number.
   6670 
   6671    * What compiler (and its version) was used to compile `ld'--e.g.
   6672      "`gcc-2.7'".
   6673 
   6674    * The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
   6675      observe the bug.  To guarantee you will not omit something
   6676      important, list them all.  A copy of the Makefile (or the output
   6677      from make) is sufficient.
   6678 
   6679      If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess
   6680      wrong and then we might not encounter the bug.
   6681 
   6682    * A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce
   6683      the bug.  It is generally most helpful to send the actual object
   6684      files provided that they are reasonably small.  Say no more than
   6685      10K.  For bigger files you can either make them available by FTP
   6686      or HTTP or else state that you are willing to send the object
   6687      file(s) to whomever requests them.  (Note - your email will be
   6688      going to a mailing list, so we do not want to clog it up with
   6689      large attachments).  But small attachments are best.
   6690 
   6691      If the source files were assembled using `gas' or compiled using
   6692      `gcc', then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
   6693      object files.  In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
   6694      `gas' or `gcc' was used to produce the object files.  Also say how
   6695      `gas' or `gcc' were configured.
   6696 
   6697    * A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
   6698      incorrect.  For example, "It gets a fatal signal."
   6699 
   6700      Of course, if the bug is that `ld' gets a fatal signal, then we
   6701      will certainly notice it.  But if the bug is incorrect output, we
   6702      might not notice unless it is glaringly wrong.  You might as well
   6703      not give us a chance to make a mistake.
   6704 
   6705      Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should
   6706      still say so explicitly.  Suppose something strange is going on,
   6707      such as, your copy of `ld' is out of sync, or you have encountered
   6708      a bug in the C library on your system.  (This has happened!)  Your
   6709      copy might crash and ours would not.  If you told us to expect a
   6710      crash, then when ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug
   6711      was not happening for us.  If you had not told us to expect a
   6712      crash, then we would not be able to draw any conclusion from our
   6713      observations.
   6714 
   6715    * If you wish to suggest changes to the `ld' source, send us context
   6716      diffs, as generated by `diff' with the `-u', `-c', or `-p' option.
   6717      Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.  If you even
   6718      discuss something in the `ld' source, refer to it by context, not
   6719      by line number.
   6720 
   6721      The line numbers in our development sources will not match those
   6722      in your sources.  Your line numbers would convey no useful
   6723      information to us.
   6724 
   6725    Here are some things that are not necessary:
   6726 
   6727    * A description of the envelope of the bug.
   6728 
   6729      Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
   6730      which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
   6731      changes will not affect it.
   6732 
   6733      This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way
   6734      we will find the bug is by running a single example under the
   6735      debugger with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of
   6736      examples.  We recommend that you save your time for something else.
   6737 
   6738      Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report _instead_
   6739      of the original one, that is a convenience for us.  Errors in the
   6740      output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
   6741      less time, and so on.
   6742 
   6743      However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do
   6744      this, report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you
   6745      used.
   6746 
   6747    * A patch for the bug.
   6748 
   6749      A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one.  But do not
   6750      omit the necessary information, such as the test case, on the
   6751      assumption that a patch is all we need.  We might see problems
   6752      with your patch and decide to fix the problem another way, or we
   6753      might not understand it at all.
   6754 
   6755      Sometimes with a program as complicated as `ld' it is very hard to
   6756      construct an example that will make the program follow a certain
   6757      path through the code.  If you do not send us the example, we will
   6758      not be able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify
   6759      that the bug is fixed.
   6760 
   6761      And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why
   6762      your patch should be an improvement, we will not install it.  A
   6763      test case will help us to understand.
   6764 
   6765    * A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
   6766 
   6767      Such guesses are usually wrong.  Even we cannot guess right about
   6768      such things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
   6769 
   6770 
   6771 File: ld.info,  Node: MRI,  Next: GNU Free Documentation License,  Prev: Reporting Bugs,  Up: Top
   6772 
   6773 Appendix A MRI Compatible Script Files
   6774 **************************************
   6775 
   6776 To aid users making the transition to GNU `ld' from the MRI linker,
   6777 `ld' can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an alternative to the
   6778 more general-purpose linker scripting language described in *Note
   6779 Scripts::.  MRI compatible linker scripts have a much simpler command
   6780 set than the scripting language otherwise used with `ld'.  GNU `ld'
   6781 supports the most commonly used MRI linker commands; these commands are
   6782 described here.
   6783 
   6784    In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the `a.out' object
   6785 file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
   6786 features to make use of them.
   6787 
   6788    You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
   6789 `-c' command-line option.
   6790 
   6791    Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
   6792 command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
   6793 blank lines are also allowed for punctuation).  If a line of an
   6794 MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, `ld' issues
   6795 a warning message, but continues processing the script.
   6796 
   6797    Lines beginning with `*' are comments.
   6798 
   6799    You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
   6800 lower case; for example, `chip' is the same as `CHIP'.  The following
   6801 list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
   6802 
   6803 `ABSOLUTE SECNAME'
   6804 `ABSOLUTE SECNAME, SECNAME, ... SECNAME'
   6805      Normally, `ld' includes in the output file all sections from all
   6806      the input files.  However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can
   6807      use the `ABSOLUTE' command to restrict the sections that will be
   6808      present in your output program.  If the `ABSOLUTE' command is used
   6809      at all in a script, then only the sections named explicitly in
   6810      `ABSOLUTE' commands will appear in the linker output.  You can
   6811      still use other input sections (whatever you select on the command
   6812      line, or using `LOAD') to resolve addresses in the output file.
   6813 
   6814 `ALIAS OUT-SECNAME, IN-SECNAME'
   6815      Use this command to place the data from input section IN-SECNAME
   6816      in a section called OUT-SECNAME in the linker output file.
   6817 
   6818      IN-SECNAME may be an integer.
   6819 
   6820 `ALIGN SECNAME = EXPRESSION'
   6821      Align the section called SECNAME to EXPRESSION.  The EXPRESSION
   6822      should be a power of two.
   6823 
   6824 `BASE EXPRESSION'
   6825      Use the value of EXPRESSION as the lowest address (other than
   6826      absolute addresses) in the output file.
   6827 
   6828 `CHIP EXPRESSION'
   6829 `CHIP EXPRESSION, EXPRESSION'
   6830      This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
   6831 
   6832 `END'
   6833      This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for
   6834      compatibility.
   6835 
   6836 `FORMAT OUTPUT-FORMAT'
   6837      Similar to the `OUTPUT_FORMAT' command in the more general linker
   6838      language, but restricted to one of these output formats:
   6839 
   6840        1. S-records, if OUTPUT-FORMAT is `S'
   6841 
   6842        2. IEEE, if OUTPUT-FORMAT is `IEEE'
   6843 
   6844        3. COFF (the `coff-m68k' variant in BFD), if OUTPUT-FORMAT is
   6845           `COFF'
   6846 
   6847 `LIST ANYTHING...'
   6848      Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
   6849      `ld' command-line option `-M'.
   6850 
   6851      The keyword `LIST' may be followed by anything on the same line,
   6852      with no change in its effect.
   6853 
   6854 `LOAD FILENAME'
   6855 `LOAD FILENAME, FILENAME, ... FILENAME'
   6856      Include one or more object file FILENAME in the link; this has the
   6857      same effect as specifying FILENAME directly on the `ld' command
   6858      line.
   6859 
   6860 `NAME OUTPUT-NAME'
   6861      OUTPUT-NAME is the name for the program produced by `ld'; the
   6862      MRI-compatible command `NAME' is equivalent to the command-line
   6863      option `-o' or the general script language command `OUTPUT'.
   6864 
   6865 `ORDER SECNAME, SECNAME, ... SECNAME'
   6866 `ORDER SECNAME SECNAME SECNAME'
   6867      Normally, `ld' orders the sections in its output file in the order
   6868      in which they first appear in the input files.  In an
   6869      MRI-compatible script, you can override this ordering with the
   6870      `ORDER' command.  The sections you list with `ORDER' will appear
   6871      first in your output file, in the order specified.
   6872 
   6873 `PUBLIC NAME=EXPRESSION'
   6874 `PUBLIC NAME,EXPRESSION'
   6875 `PUBLIC NAME EXPRESSION'
   6876      Supply a value (EXPRESSION) for external symbol NAME used in the
   6877      linker input files.
   6878 
   6879 `SECT SECNAME, EXPRESSION'
   6880 `SECT SECNAME=EXPRESSION'
   6881 `SECT SECNAME EXPRESSION'
   6882      You can use any of these three forms of the `SECT' command to
   6883      specify the start address (EXPRESSION) for section SECNAME.  If
   6884      you have more than one `SECT' statement for the same SECNAME, only
   6885      the _first_ sets the start address.
   6886 
   6887 
   6888 File: ld.info,  Node: GNU Free Documentation License,  Next: LD Index,  Prev: MRI,  Up: Top
   6889 
   6890 Appendix B GNU Free Documentation License
   6891 *****************************************
   6892 
   6893                      Version 1.3, 3 November 2008
   6894 
   6895      Copyright (C) 2000, 2001, 2002, 2007, 2008 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
   6896      `http://fsf.org/'
   6897 
   6898      Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
   6899      of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
   6900 
   6901   0. PREAMBLE
   6902 
   6903      The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other
   6904      functional and useful document "free" in the sense of freedom: to
   6905      assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it,
   6906      with or without modifying it, either commercially or
   6907      noncommercially.  Secondarily, this License preserves for the
   6908      author and publisher a way to get credit for their work, while not
   6909      being considered responsible for modifications made by others.
   6910 
   6911      This License is a kind of "copyleft", which means that derivative
   6912      works of the document must themselves be free in the same sense.
   6913      It complements the GNU General Public License, which is a copyleft
   6914      license designed for free software.
   6915 
   6916      We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for
   6917      free software, because free software needs free documentation: a
   6918      free program should come with manuals providing the same freedoms
   6919      that the software does.  But this License is not limited to
   6920      software manuals; it can be used for any textual work, regardless
   6921      of subject matter or whether it is published as a printed book.
   6922      We recommend this License principally for works whose purpose is
   6923      instruction or reference.
   6924 
   6925   1. APPLICABILITY AND DEFINITIONS
   6926 
   6927      This License applies to any manual or other work, in any medium,
   6928      that contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it
   6929      can be distributed under the terms of this License.  Such a notice
   6930      grants a world-wide, royalty-free license, unlimited in duration,
   6931      to use that work under the conditions stated herein.  The
   6932      "Document", below, refers to any such manual or work.  Any member
   6933      of the public is a licensee, and is addressed as "you".  You
   6934      accept the license if you copy, modify or distribute the work in a
   6935      way requiring permission under copyright law.
   6936 
   6937      A "Modified Version" of the Document means any work containing the
   6938      Document or a portion of it, either copied verbatim, or with
   6939      modifications and/or translated into another language.
   6940 
   6941      A "Secondary Section" is a named appendix or a front-matter section
   6942      of the Document that deals exclusively with the relationship of the
   6943      publishers or authors of the Document to the Document's overall
   6944      subject (or to related matters) and contains nothing that could
   6945      fall directly within that overall subject.  (Thus, if the Document
   6946      is in part a textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may not
   6947      explain any mathematics.)  The relationship could be a matter of
   6948      historical connection with the subject or with related matters, or
   6949      of legal, commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position
   6950      regarding them.
   6951 
   6952      The "Invariant Sections" are certain Secondary Sections whose
   6953      titles are designated, as being those of Invariant Sections, in
   6954      the notice that says that the Document is released under this
   6955      License.  If a section does not fit the above definition of
   6956      Secondary then it is not allowed to be designated as Invariant.
   6957      The Document may contain zero Invariant Sections.  If the Document
   6958      does not identify any Invariant Sections then there are none.
   6959 
   6960      The "Cover Texts" are certain short passages of text that are
   6961      listed, as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice
   6962      that says that the Document is released under this License.  A
   6963      Front-Cover Text may be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may
   6964      be at most 25 words.
   6965 
   6966      A "Transparent" copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy,
   6967      represented in a format whose specification is available to the
   6968      general public, that is suitable for revising the document
   6969      straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images
   6970      composed of pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some
   6971      widely available drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to
   6972      text formatters or for automatic translation to a variety of
   6973      formats suitable for input to text formatters.  A copy made in an
   6974      otherwise Transparent file format whose markup, or absence of
   6975      markup, has been arranged to thwart or discourage subsequent
   6976      modification by readers is not Transparent.  An image format is
   6977      not Transparent if used for any substantial amount of text.  A
   6978      copy that is not "Transparent" is called "Opaque".
   6979 
   6980      Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain
   6981      ASCII without markup, Texinfo input format, LaTeX input format,
   6982      SGML or XML using a publicly available DTD, and
   6983      standard-conforming simple HTML, PostScript or PDF designed for
   6984      human modification.  Examples of transparent image formats include
   6985      PNG, XCF and JPG.  Opaque formats include proprietary formats that
   6986      can be read and edited only by proprietary word processors, SGML or
   6987      XML for which the DTD and/or processing tools are not generally
   6988      available, and the machine-generated HTML, PostScript or PDF
   6989      produced by some word processors for output purposes only.
   6990 
   6991      The "Title Page" means, for a printed book, the title page itself,
   6992      plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the
   6993      material this License requires to appear in the title page.  For
   6994      works in formats which do not have any title page as such, "Title
   6995      Page" means the text near the most prominent appearance of the
   6996      work's title, preceding the beginning of the body of the text.
   6997 
   6998      The "publisher" means any person or entity that distributes copies
   6999      of the Document to the public.
   7000 
   7001      A section "Entitled XYZ" means a named subunit of the Document
   7002      whose title either is precisely XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses
   7003      following text that translates XYZ in another language.  (Here XYZ
   7004      stands for a specific section name mentioned below, such as
   7005      "Acknowledgements", "Dedications", "Endorsements", or "History".)
   7006      To "Preserve the Title" of such a section when you modify the
   7007      Document means that it remains a section "Entitled XYZ" according
   7008      to this definition.
   7009 
   7010      The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice
   7011      which states that this License applies to the Document.  These
   7012      Warranty Disclaimers are considered to be included by reference in
   7013      this License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other
   7014      implication that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and
   7015      has no effect on the meaning of this License.
   7016 
   7017   2. VERBATIM COPYING
   7018 
   7019      You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either
   7020      commercially or noncommercially, provided that this License, the
   7021      copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License
   7022      applies to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you
   7023      add no other conditions whatsoever to those of this License.  You
   7024      may not use technical measures to obstruct or control the reading
   7025      or further copying of the copies you make or distribute.  However,
   7026      you may accept compensation in exchange for copies.  If you
   7027      distribute a large enough number of copies you must also follow
   7028      the conditions in section 3.
   7029 
   7030      You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above,
   7031      and you may publicly display copies.
   7032 
   7033   3. COPYING IN QUANTITY
   7034 
   7035      If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly
   7036      have printed covers) of the Document, numbering more than 100, and
   7037      the Document's license notice requires Cover Texts, you must
   7038      enclose the copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all
   7039      these Cover Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and
   7040      Back-Cover Texts on the back cover.  Both covers must also clearly
   7041      and legibly identify you as the publisher of these copies.  The
   7042      front cover must present the full title with all words of the
   7043      title equally prominent and visible.  You may add other material
   7044      on the covers in addition.  Copying with changes limited to the
   7045      covers, as long as they preserve the title of the Document and
   7046      satisfy these conditions, can be treated as verbatim copying in
   7047      other respects.
   7048 
   7049      If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit
   7050      legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit
   7051      reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto
   7052      adjacent pages.
   7053 
   7054      If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document
   7055      numbering more than 100, you must either include a
   7056      machine-readable Transparent copy along with each Opaque copy, or
   7057      state in or with each Opaque copy a computer-network location from
   7058      which the general network-using public has access to download
   7059      using public-standard network protocols a complete Transparent
   7060      copy of the Document, free of added material.  If you use the
   7061      latter option, you must take reasonably prudent steps, when you
   7062      begin distribution of Opaque copies in quantity, to ensure that
   7063      this Transparent copy will remain thus accessible at the stated
   7064      location until at least one year after the last time you
   7065      distribute an Opaque copy (directly or through your agents or
   7066      retailers) of that edition to the public.
   7067 
   7068      It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of
   7069      the Document well before redistributing any large number of
   7070      copies, to give them a chance to provide you with an updated
   7071      version of the Document.
   7072 
   7073   4. MODIFICATIONS
   7074 
   7075      You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document
   7076      under the conditions of sections 2 and 3 above, provided that you
   7077      release the Modified Version under precisely this License, with
   7078      the Modified Version filling the role of the Document, thus
   7079      licensing distribution and modification of the Modified Version to
   7080      whoever possesses a copy of it.  In addition, you must do these
   7081      things in the Modified Version:
   7082 
   7083        A. Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title
   7084           distinct from that of the Document, and from those of
   7085           previous versions (which should, if there were any, be listed
   7086           in the History section of the Document).  You may use the
   7087           same title as a previous version if the original publisher of
   7088           that version gives permission.
   7089 
   7090        B. List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or
   7091           entities responsible for authorship of the modifications in
   7092           the Modified Version, together with at least five of the
   7093           principal authors of the Document (all of its principal
   7094           authors, if it has fewer than five), unless they release you
   7095           from this requirement.
   7096 
   7097        C. State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the
   7098           Modified Version, as the publisher.
   7099 
   7100        D. Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document.
   7101 
   7102        E. Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications
   7103           adjacent to the other copyright notices.
   7104 
   7105        F. Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license
   7106           notice giving the public permission to use the Modified
   7107           Version under the terms of this License, in the form shown in
   7108           the Addendum below.
   7109 
   7110        G. Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant
   7111           Sections and required Cover Texts given in the Document's
   7112           license notice.
   7113 
   7114        H. Include an unaltered copy of this License.
   7115 
   7116        I. Preserve the section Entitled "History", Preserve its Title,
   7117           and add to it an item stating at least the title, year, new
   7118           authors, and publisher of the Modified Version as given on
   7119           the Title Page.  If there is no section Entitled "History" in
   7120           the Document, create one stating the title, year, authors,
   7121           and publisher of the Document as given on its Title Page,
   7122           then add an item describing the Modified Version as stated in
   7123           the previous sentence.
   7124 
   7125        J. Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document
   7126           for public access to a Transparent copy of the Document, and
   7127           likewise the network locations given in the Document for
   7128           previous versions it was based on.  These may be placed in
   7129           the "History" section.  You may omit a network location for a
   7130           work that was published at least four years before the
   7131           Document itself, or if the original publisher of the version
   7132           it refers to gives permission.
   7133 
   7134        K. For any section Entitled "Acknowledgements" or "Dedications",
   7135           Preserve the Title of the section, and preserve in the
   7136           section all the substance and tone of each of the contributor
   7137           acknowledgements and/or dedications given therein.
   7138 
   7139        L. Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document,
   7140           unaltered in their text and in their titles.  Section numbers
   7141           or the equivalent are not considered part of the section
   7142           titles.
   7143 
   7144        M. Delete any section Entitled "Endorsements".  Such a section
   7145           may not be included in the Modified Version.
   7146 
   7147        N. Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled
   7148           "Endorsements" or to conflict in title with any Invariant
   7149           Section.
   7150 
   7151        O. Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers.
   7152 
   7153      If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or
   7154      appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no
   7155      material copied from the Document, you may at your option
   7156      designate some or all of these sections as invariant.  To do this,
   7157      add their titles to the list of Invariant Sections in the Modified
   7158      Version's license notice.  These titles must be distinct from any
   7159      other section titles.
   7160 
   7161      You may add a section Entitled "Endorsements", provided it contains
   7162      nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by various
   7163      parties--for example, statements of peer review or that the text
   7164      has been approved by an organization as the authoritative
   7165      definition of a standard.
   7166 
   7167      You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text,
   7168      and a passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end
   7169      of the list of Cover Texts in the Modified Version.  Only one
   7170      passage of Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be
   7171      added by (or through arrangements made by) any one entity.  If the
   7172      Document already includes a cover text for the same cover,
   7173      previously added by you or by arrangement made by the same entity
   7174      you are acting on behalf of, you may not add another; but you may
   7175      replace the old one, on explicit permission from the previous
   7176      publisher that added the old one.
   7177 
   7178      The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this
   7179      License give permission to use their names for publicity for or to
   7180      assert or imply endorsement of any Modified Version.
   7181 
   7182   5. COMBINING DOCUMENTS
   7183 
   7184      You may combine the Document with other documents released under
   7185      this License, under the terms defined in section 4 above for
   7186      modified versions, provided that you include in the combination
   7187      all of the Invariant Sections of all of the original documents,
   7188      unmodified, and list them all as Invariant Sections of your
   7189      combined work in its license notice, and that you preserve all
   7190      their Warranty Disclaimers.
   7191 
   7192      The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and
   7193      multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single
   7194      copy.  If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name
   7195      but different contents, make the title of each such section unique
   7196      by adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the
   7197      original author or publisher of that section if known, or else a
   7198      unique number.  Make the same adjustment to the section titles in
   7199      the list of Invariant Sections in the license notice of the
   7200      combined work.
   7201 
   7202      In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled
   7203      "History" in the various original documents, forming one section
   7204      Entitled "History"; likewise combine any sections Entitled
   7205      "Acknowledgements", and any sections Entitled "Dedications".  You
   7206      must delete all sections Entitled "Endorsements."
   7207 
   7208   6. COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS
   7209 
   7210      You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other
   7211      documents released under this License, and replace the individual
   7212      copies of this License in the various documents with a single copy
   7213      that is included in the collection, provided that you follow the
   7214      rules of this License for verbatim copying of each of the
   7215      documents in all other respects.
   7216 
   7217      You may extract a single document from such a collection, and
   7218      distribute it individually under this License, provided you insert
   7219      a copy of this License into the extracted document, and follow
   7220      this License in all other respects regarding verbatim copying of
   7221      that document.
   7222 
   7223   7. AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS
   7224 
   7225      A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other
   7226      separate and independent documents or works, in or on a volume of
   7227      a storage or distribution medium, is called an "aggregate" if the
   7228      copyright resulting from the compilation is not used to limit the
   7229      legal rights of the compilation's users beyond what the individual
   7230      works permit.  When the Document is included in an aggregate, this
   7231      License does not apply to the other works in the aggregate which
   7232      are not themselves derivative works of the Document.
   7233 
   7234      If the Cover Text requirement of section 3 is applicable to these
   7235      copies of the Document, then if the Document is less than one half
   7236      of the entire aggregate, the Document's Cover Texts may be placed
   7237      on covers that bracket the Document within the aggregate, or the
   7238      electronic equivalent of covers if the Document is in electronic
   7239      form.  Otherwise they must appear on printed covers that bracket
   7240      the whole aggregate.
   7241 
   7242   8. TRANSLATION
   7243 
   7244      Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may
   7245      distribute translations of the Document under the terms of section
   7246      4.  Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special
   7247      permission from their copyright holders, but you may include
   7248      translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition to the
   7249      original versions of these Invariant Sections.  You may include a
   7250      translation of this License, and all the license notices in the
   7251      Document, and any Warranty Disclaimers, provided that you also
   7252      include the original English version of this License and the
   7253      original versions of those notices and disclaimers.  In case of a
   7254      disagreement between the translation and the original version of
   7255      this License or a notice or disclaimer, the original version will
   7256      prevail.
   7257 
   7258      If a section in the Document is Entitled "Acknowledgements",
   7259      "Dedications", or "History", the requirement (section 4) to
   7260      Preserve its Title (section 1) will typically require changing the
   7261      actual title.
   7262 
   7263   9. TERMINATION
   7264 
   7265      You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document
   7266      except as expressly provided under this License.  Any attempt
   7267      otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute it is void,
   7268      and will automatically terminate your rights under this License.
   7269 
   7270      However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your
   7271      license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a)
   7272      provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly
   7273      and finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the
   7274      copyright holder fails to notify you of the violation by some
   7275      reasonable means prior to 60 days after the cessation.
   7276 
   7277      Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is
   7278      reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the
   7279      violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have
   7280      received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from
   7281      that copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days
   7282      after your receipt of the notice.
   7283 
   7284      Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate
   7285      the licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from
   7286      you under this License.  If your rights have been terminated and
   7287      not permanently reinstated, receipt of a copy of some or all of
   7288      the same material does not give you any rights to use it.
   7289 
   7290  10. FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE
   7291 
   7292      The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions of
   7293      the GNU Free Documentation License from time to time.  Such new
   7294      versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may
   7295      differ in detail to address new problems or concerns.  See
   7296      `http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/'.
   7297 
   7298      Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version
   7299      number.  If the Document specifies that a particular numbered
   7300      version of this License "or any later version" applies to it, you
   7301      have the option of following the terms and conditions either of
   7302      that specified version or of any later version that has been
   7303      published (not as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation.  If
   7304      the Document does not specify a version number of this License,
   7305      you may choose any version ever published (not as a draft) by the
   7306      Free Software Foundation.  If the Document specifies that a proxy
   7307      can decide which future versions of this License can be used, that
   7308      proxy's public statement of acceptance of a version permanently
   7309      authorizes you to choose that version for the Document.
   7310 
   7311  11. RELICENSING
   7312 
   7313      "Massive Multiauthor Collaboration Site" (or "MMC Site") means any
   7314      World Wide Web server that publishes copyrightable works and also
   7315      provides prominent facilities for anybody to edit those works.  A
   7316      public wiki that anybody can edit is an example of such a server.
   7317      A "Massive Multiauthor Collaboration" (or "MMC") contained in the
   7318      site means any set of copyrightable works thus published on the MMC
   7319      site.
   7320 
   7321      "CC-BY-SA" means the Creative Commons Attribution-Share Alike 3.0
   7322      license published by Creative Commons Corporation, a not-for-profit
   7323      corporation with a principal place of business in San Francisco,
   7324      California, as well as future copyleft versions of that license
   7325      published by that same organization.
   7326 
   7327      "Incorporate" means to publish or republish a Document, in whole or
   7328      in part, as part of another Document.
   7329 
   7330      An MMC is "eligible for relicensing" if it is licensed under this
   7331      License, and if all works that were first published under this
   7332      License somewhere other than this MMC, and subsequently
   7333      incorporated in whole or in part into the MMC, (1) had no cover
   7334      texts or invariant sections, and (2) were thus incorporated prior
   7335      to November 1, 2008.
   7336 
   7337      The operator of an MMC Site may republish an MMC contained in the
   7338      site under CC-BY-SA on the same site at any time before August 1,
   7339      2009, provided the MMC is eligible for relicensing.
   7340 
   7341 
   7342 ADDENDUM: How to use this License for your documents
   7343 ====================================================
   7344 
   7345 To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of
   7346 the License in the document and put the following copyright and license
   7347 notices just after the title page:
   7348 
   7349        Copyright (C)  YEAR  YOUR NAME.
   7350        Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
   7351        under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
   7352        or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
   7353        with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover
   7354        Texts.  A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
   7355        Free Documentation License''.
   7356 
   7357    If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover
   7358 Texts, replace the "with...Texts." line with this:
   7359 
   7360          with the Invariant Sections being LIST THEIR TITLES, with
   7361          the Front-Cover Texts being LIST, and with the Back-Cover Texts
   7362          being LIST.
   7363 
   7364    If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other
   7365 combination of the three, merge those two alternatives to suit the
   7366 situation.
   7367 
   7368    If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we
   7369 recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your choice of
   7370 free software license, such as the GNU General Public License, to
   7371 permit their use in free software.
   7372 
   7373 
   7374 File: ld.info,  Node: LD Index,  Prev: GNU Free Documentation License,  Up: Top
   7375 
   7376 LD Index
   7377 ********
   7378 
   7379 [index]
   7380 * Menu:
   7381 
   7382 * ":                                     Symbols.            (line    6)
   7383 * -(:                                    Options.            (line  731)
   7384 * --accept-unknown-input-arch:           Options.            (line  749)
   7385 * --add-needed:                          Options.            (line  777)
   7386 * --add-stdcall-alias:                   Options.            (line 1635)
   7387 * --allow-multiple-definition:           Options.            (line 1029)
   7388 * --allow-shlib-undefined:               Options.            (line 1035)
   7389 * --architecture=ARCH:                   Options.            (line  123)
   7390 * --as-needed:                           Options.            (line  759)
   7391 * --audit AUDITLIB:                      Options.            (line  112)
   7392 * --auxiliary=NAME:                      Options.            (line  255)
   7393 * --bank-window:                         Options.            (line 2089)
   7394 * --base-file:                           Options.            (line 1640)
   7395 * --be8:                                 ARM.                (line   28)
   7396 * --bss-plt:                             PowerPC ELF32.      (line   16)
   7397 * --build-id:                            Options.            (line 1597)
   7398 * --build-id=STYLE:                      Options.            (line 1597)
   7399 * --check-sections:                      Options.            (line  856)
   7400 * --copy-dt-needed-entries:              Options.            (line  868)
   7401 * --cref:                                Options.            (line  888)
   7402 * --default-imported-symver:             Options.            (line 1072)
   7403 * --default-script=SCRIPT:               Options.            (line  562)
   7404 * --default-symver:                      Options.            (line 1068)
   7405 * --defsym=SYMBOL=EXP:                   Options.            (line  917)
   7406 * --demangle[=STYLE]:                    Options.            (line  930)
   7407 * --depaudit AUDITLIB:                   Options.            (line  177)
   7408 * --disable-auto-image-base:             Options.            (line 1827)
   7409 * --disable-auto-import:                 Options.            (line 1962)
   7410 * --disable-large-address-aware:         Options.            (line 1766)
   7411 * --disable-long-section-names:          Options.            (line 1650)
   7412 * --disable-new-dtags:                   Options.            (line 1559)
   7413 * --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc:        Options.            (line 1975)
   7414 * --disable-stdcall-fixup:               Options.            (line 1672)
   7415 * --discard-all:                         Options.            (line  608)
   7416 * --discard-locals:                      Options.            (line  612)
   7417 * --dll:                                 Options.            (line 1645)
   7418 * --dll-search-prefix:                   Options.            (line 1833)
   7419 * --dotsyms:                             PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   33)
   7420 * --dsbt-index:                          Options.            (line 2066)
   7421 * --dsbt-size:                           Options.            (line 2061)
   7422 * --dynamic-linker=FILE:                 Options.            (line  943)
   7423 * --dynamic-list-cpp-new:                Options.            (line  848)
   7424 * --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo:           Options.            (line  852)
   7425 * --dynamic-list-data:                   Options.            (line  845)
   7426 * --dynamic-list=DYNAMIC-LIST-FILE:      Options.            (line  832)
   7427 * --dynamicbase:                         Options.            (line 2015)
   7428 * --eh-frame-hdr:                        Options.            (line 1550)
   7429 * --emit-relocs:                         Options.            (line  497)
   7430 * --emit-stack-syms:                     SPU ELF.            (line   46)
   7431 * --emit-stub-syms <1>:                  SPU ELF.            (line   15)
   7432 * --emit-stub-syms <2>:                  PowerPC ELF32.      (line   47)
   7433 * --emit-stub-syms:                      PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   29)
   7434 * --enable-auto-image-base:              Options.            (line 1818)
   7435 * --enable-auto-import:                  Options.            (line 1842)
   7436 * --enable-extra-pe-debug:               Options.            (line 1980)
   7437 * --enable-long-section-names:           Options.            (line 1650)
   7438 * --enable-new-dtags:                    Options.            (line 1559)
   7439 * --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc:         Options.            (line 1967)
   7440 * --enable-stdcall-fixup:                Options.            (line 1672)
   7441 * --entry=ENTRY:                         Options.            (line  187)
   7442 * --error-unresolved-symbols:            Options.            (line 1503)
   7443 * --exclude-all-symbols:                 Options.            (line 1726)
   7444 * --exclude-libs:                        Options.            (line  197)
   7445 * --exclude-modules-for-implib:          Options.            (line  208)
   7446 * --exclude-symbols:                     Options.            (line 1720)
   7447 * --export-all-symbols:                  Options.            (line 1696)
   7448 * --export-dynamic:                      Options.            (line  221)
   7449 * --extra-overlay-stubs:                 SPU ELF.            (line   19)
   7450 * --fatal-warnings:                      Options.            (line  950)
   7451 * --file-alignment:                      Options.            (line 1730)
   7452 * --filter=NAME:                         Options.            (line  276)
   7453 * --fix-arm1176:                         ARM.                (line  111)
   7454 * --fix-cortex-a53-835769:               ARM.                (line  174)
   7455 * --fix-cortex-a8:                       ARM.                (line  165)
   7456 * --fix-v4bx:                            ARM.                (line   49)
   7457 * --fix-v4bx-interworking:               ARM.                (line   62)
   7458 * --force-dynamic:                       Options.            (line  506)
   7459 * --force-exe-suffix:                    Options.            (line  955)
   7460 * --forceinteg:                          Options.            (line 2020)
   7461 * --format=FORMAT:                       Options.            (line  134)
   7462 * --format=VERSION:                      TI COFF.            (line    6)
   7463 * --gc-sections:                         Options.            (line  965)
   7464 * --got:                                 Options.            (line 2102)
   7465 * --got=TYPE:                            M68K.               (line    6)
   7466 * --gpsize=VALUE:                        Options.            (line  309)
   7467 * --hash-size=NUMBER:                    Options.            (line 1569)
   7468 * --hash-style=STYLE:                    Options.            (line 1577)
   7469 * --heap:                                Options.            (line 1736)
   7470 * --help:                                Options.            (line 1002)
   7471 * --high-entropy-va:                     Options.            (line 2011)
   7472 * --image-base:                          Options.            (line 1743)
   7473 * --insert-timestamp:                    Options.            (line 2043)
   7474 * --insn32 <1>:                          MIPS.               (line    6)
   7475 * --insn32:                              Options.            (line 2114)
   7476 * --just-symbols=FILE:                   Options.            (line  529)
   7477 * --kill-at:                             Options.            (line 1752)
   7478 * --large-address-aware:                 Options.            (line 1757)
   7479 * --ld-generated-unwind-info:            Options.            (line 1554)
   7480 * --leading-underscore:                  Options.            (line 1690)
   7481 * --library-path=DIR:                    Options.            (line  367)
   7482 * --library=NAMESPEC:                    Options.            (line  334)
   7483 * --local-store=lo:hi:                   SPU ELF.            (line   24)
   7484 * --long-plt:                            ARM.                (line  185)
   7485 * --major-image-version:                 Options.            (line 1773)
   7486 * --major-os-version:                    Options.            (line 1778)
   7487 * --major-subsystem-version:             Options.            (line 1782)
   7488 * --merge-exidx-entries:                 ARM.                (line  182)
   7489 * --minor-image-version:                 Options.            (line 1787)
   7490 * --minor-os-version:                    Options.            (line 1792)
   7491 * --minor-subsystem-version:             Options.            (line 1796)
   7492 * --mri-script=MRI-CMDFILE:              Options.            (line  158)
   7493 * --multi-subspace:                      HPPA ELF32.         (line    6)
   7494 * --nmagic:                              Options.            (line  439)
   7495 * --no-accept-unknown-input-arch:        Options.            (line  749)
   7496 * --no-add-needed:                       Options.            (line  777)
   7497 * --no-allow-shlib-undefined:            Options.            (line 1035)
   7498 * --no-as-needed:                        Options.            (line  759)
   7499 * --no-bind:                             Options.            (line 2034)
   7500 * --no-check-sections:                   Options.            (line  856)
   7501 * --no-copy-dt-needed-entries:           Options.            (line  868)
   7502 * --no-define-common:                    Options.            (line  901)
   7503 * --no-demangle:                         Options.            (line  930)
   7504 * --no-dotsyms:                          PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   33)
   7505 * --no-enum-size-warning:                ARM.                (line  120)
   7506 * --no-export-dynamic:                   Options.            (line  221)
   7507 * --no-fatal-warnings:                   Options.            (line  950)
   7508 * --no-fix-arm1176:                      ARM.                (line  111)
   7509 * --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769:            ARM.                (line  174)
   7510 * --no-fix-cortex-a8:                    ARM.                (line  165)
   7511 * --no-gc-sections:                      Options.            (line  965)
   7512 * --no-insn32 <1>:                       MIPS.               (line    6)
   7513 * --no-insn32:                           Options.            (line 2115)
   7514 * --no-isolation:                        Options.            (line 2027)
   7515 * --no-keep-memory:                      Options.            (line 1014)
   7516 * --no-leading-underscore:               Options.            (line 1690)
   7517 * --no-merge-exidx-entries <1>:          ARM.                (line  182)
   7518 * --no-merge-exidx-entries:              Options.            (line 2073)
   7519 * --no-multi-toc:                        PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   74)
   7520 * --no-omagic:                           Options.            (line  454)
   7521 * --no-opd-optimize:                     PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   48)
   7522 * --no-overlays:                         SPU ELF.            (line    9)
   7523 * --no-plt-align:                        PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   96)
   7524 * --no-plt-static-chain:                 PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line  104)
   7525 * --no-plt-thread-safe:                  PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line  110)
   7526 * --no-print-gc-sections:                Options.            (line  987)
   7527 * --no-seh:                              Options.            (line 2030)
   7528 * --no-tls-optimize <1>:                 PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   43)
   7529 * --no-tls-optimize:                     PowerPC ELF32.      (line   51)
   7530 * --no-toc-optimize:                     PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   60)
   7531 * --no-toc-sort:                         PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   86)
   7532 * --no-trampoline:                       Options.            (line 2083)
   7533 * --no-undefined:                        Options.            (line 1021)
   7534 * --no-undefined-version:                Options.            (line 1063)
   7535 * --no-warn-mismatch:                    Options.            (line 1076)
   7536 * --no-warn-search-mismatch:             Options.            (line 1085)
   7537 * --no-wchar-size-warning:               ARM.                (line  127)
   7538 * --no-whole-archive:                    Options.            (line 1089)
   7539 * --noinhibit-exec:                      Options.            (line 1093)
   7540 * --non-overlapping-opd:                 PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   54)
   7541 * --nxcompat:                            Options.            (line 2023)
   7542 * --oformat=OUTPUT-FORMAT:               Options.            (line 1105)
   7543 * --omagic:                              Options.            (line  445)
   7544 * --out-implib:                          Options.            (line 1809)
   7545 * --output-def:                          Options.            (line 1801)
   7546 * --output=OUTPUT:                       Options.            (line  460)
   7547 * --pic-executable:                      Options.            (line 1118)
   7548 * --pic-veneer:                          ARM.                (line  133)
   7549 * --plt-align:                           PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   96)
   7550 * --plt-static-chain:                    PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line  104)
   7551 * --plt-thread-safe:                     PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line  110)
   7552 * --plugin:                              SPU ELF.            (line    6)
   7553 * --pop-state:                           Options.            (line  494)
   7554 * --print-gc-sections:                   Options.            (line  987)
   7555 * --print-map:                           Options.            (line  402)
   7556 * --print-output-format:                 Options.            (line  996)
   7557 * --push-state:                          Options.            (line  476)
   7558 * --reduce-memory-overheads:             Options.            (line 1583)
   7559 * --relax:                               Options.            (line 1134)
   7560 * --relax on i960:                       i960.               (line   31)
   7561 * --relax on Nios II:                    Nios II.            (line    6)
   7562 * --relax on PowerPC:                    PowerPC ELF32.      (line    6)
   7563 * --relax on Xtensa:                     Xtensa.             (line   27)
   7564 * --relocatable:                         Options.            (line  510)
   7565 * --retain-symbols-file=FILENAME:        Options.            (line 1160)
   7566 * --script=SCRIPT:                       Options.            (line  553)
   7567 * --sdata-got:                           PowerPC ELF32.      (line   33)
   7568 * --section-alignment:                   Options.            (line 1985)
   7569 * --section-start=SECTIONNAME=ORG:       Options.            (line 1316)
   7570 * --secure-plt:                          PowerPC ELF32.      (line   26)
   7571 * --sort-common:                         Options.            (line 1258)
   7572 * --sort-section=alignment:              Options.            (line 1273)
   7573 * --sort-section=name:                   Options.            (line 1269)
   7574 * --split-by-file:                       Options.            (line 1277)
   7575 * --split-by-reloc:                      Options.            (line 1282)
   7576 * --stack:                               Options.            (line 1991)
   7577 * --stack-analysis:                      SPU ELF.            (line   29)
   7578 * --stats:                               Options.            (line 1295)
   7579 * --strip-all:                           Options.            (line  540)
   7580 * --strip-debug:                         Options.            (line  544)
   7581 * --stub-group-size:                     PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line    6)
   7582 * --stub-group-size=N <1>:               ARM.                (line  138)
   7583 * --stub-group-size=N:                   HPPA ELF32.         (line   12)
   7584 * --subsystem:                           Options.            (line 1998)
   7585 * --support-old-code:                    ARM.                (line    6)
   7586 * --sysroot=DIRECTORY:                   Options.            (line 1299)
   7587 * --target-help:                         Options.            (line 1006)
   7588 * --target1-abs:                         ARM.                (line   32)
   7589 * --target1-rel:                         ARM.                (line   32)
   7590 * --target2=TYPE:                        ARM.                (line   37)
   7591 * --thumb-entry=ENTRY:                   ARM.                (line   17)
   7592 * --trace:                               Options.            (line  549)
   7593 * --trace-symbol=SYMBOL:                 Options.            (line  618)
   7594 * --traditional-format:                  Options.            (line 1304)
   7595 * --tsaware:                             Options.            (line 2040)
   7596 * --undefined=SYMBOL:                    Options.            (line  575)
   7597 * --unique[=SECTION]:                    Options.            (line  593)
   7598 * --unresolved-symbols:                  Options.            (line 1346)
   7599 * --use-blx:                             ARM.                (line   74)
   7600 * --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables:      ARM.                (line   23)
   7601 * --verbose[=NUMBER]:                    Options.            (line 1375)
   7602 * --version:                             Options.            (line  602)
   7603 * --version-script=VERSION-SCRIPTFILE:   Options.            (line 1383)
   7604 * --vfp11-denorm-fix:                    ARM.                (line   83)
   7605 * --warn-alternate-em:                   Options.            (line 1495)
   7606 * --warn-common:                         Options.            (line 1394)
   7607 * --warn-constructors:                   Options.            (line 1462)
   7608 * --warn-multiple-gp:                    Options.            (line 1467)
   7609 * --warn-once:                           Options.            (line 1481)
   7610 * --warn-section-align:                  Options.            (line 1485)
   7611 * --warn-shared-textrel:                 Options.            (line 1492)
   7612 * --warn-unresolved-symbols:             Options.            (line 1498)
   7613 * --wdmdriver:                           Options.            (line 2037)
   7614 * --whole-archive:                       Options.            (line 1507)
   7615 * --wrap=SYMBOL:                         Options.            (line 1521)
   7616 * -A ARCH:                               Options.            (line  122)
   7617 * -a KEYWORD:                            Options.            (line  105)
   7618 * -assert KEYWORD:                       Options.            (line  784)
   7619 * -b FORMAT:                             Options.            (line  134)
   7620 * -Bdynamic:                             Options.            (line  787)
   7621 * -Bgroup:                               Options.            (line  797)
   7622 * -Bshareable:                           Options.            (line 1251)
   7623 * -Bstatic:                              Options.            (line  804)
   7624 * -Bsymbolic:                            Options.            (line  819)
   7625 * -Bsymbolic-functions:                  Options.            (line  826)
   7626 * -c MRI-CMDFILE:                        Options.            (line  158)
   7627 * -call_shared:                          Options.            (line  787)
   7628 * -d:                                    Options.            (line  168)
   7629 * -dc:                                   Options.            (line  168)
   7630 * -dn:                                   Options.            (line  804)
   7631 * -dp:                                   Options.            (line  168)
   7632 * -dT SCRIPT:                            Options.            (line  562)
   7633 * -dy:                                   Options.            (line  787)
   7634 * -E:                                    Options.            (line  221)
   7635 * -e ENTRY:                              Options.            (line  187)
   7636 * -EB:                                   Options.            (line  248)
   7637 * -EL:                                   Options.            (line  251)
   7638 * -F NAME:                               Options.            (line  276)
   7639 * -f NAME:                               Options.            (line  255)
   7640 * -fini=NAME:                            Options.            (line  300)
   7641 * -g:                                    Options.            (line  306)
   7642 * -G VALUE:                              Options.            (line  309)
   7643 * -h NAME:                               Options.            (line  316)
   7644 * -i:                                    Options.            (line  325)
   7645 * -IFILE:                                Options.            (line  943)
   7646 * -init=NAME:                            Options.            (line  328)
   7647 * -L DIR:                                Options.            (line  367)
   7648 * -l NAMESPEC:                           Options.            (line  334)
   7649 * -M:                                    Options.            (line  402)
   7650 * -m EMULATION:                          Options.            (line  392)
   7651 * -Map=MAPFILE:                          Options.            (line 1010)
   7652 * -N:                                    Options.            (line  445)
   7653 * -n:                                    Options.            (line  439)
   7654 * -no-relax:                             Options.            (line 1134)
   7655 * -non_shared:                           Options.            (line  804)
   7656 * -nostdlib:                             Options.            (line 1099)
   7657 * -O LEVEL:                              Options.            (line  466)
   7658 * -o OUTPUT:                             Options.            (line  460)
   7659 * -P AUDITLIB:                           Options.            (line  177)
   7660 * -pie:                                  Options.            (line 1118)
   7661 * -q:                                    Options.            (line  497)
   7662 * -qmagic:                               Options.            (line 1128)
   7663 * -Qy:                                   Options.            (line 1131)
   7664 * -r:                                    Options.            (line  510)
   7665 * -R FILE:                               Options.            (line  529)
   7666 * -rpath-link=DIR:                       Options.            (line 1196)
   7667 * -rpath=DIR:                            Options.            (line 1174)
   7668 * -S:                                    Options.            (line  544)
   7669 * -s:                                    Options.            (line  540)
   7670 * -shared:                               Options.            (line 1251)
   7671 * -soname=NAME:                          Options.            (line  316)
   7672 * -static:                               Options.            (line  804)
   7673 * -t:                                    Options.            (line  549)
   7674 * -T SCRIPT:                             Options.            (line  553)
   7675 * -Tbss=ORG:                             Options.            (line 1325)
   7676 * -Tdata=ORG:                            Options.            (line 1325)
   7677 * -Tldata-segment=ORG:                   Options.            (line 1341)
   7678 * -Trodata-segment=ORG:                  Options.            (line 1335)
   7679 * -Ttext-segment=ORG:                    Options.            (line 1331)
   7680 * -Ttext=ORG:                            Options.            (line 1325)
   7681 * -u SYMBOL:                             Options.            (line  575)
   7682 * -Ur:                                   Options.            (line  583)
   7683 * -v:                                    Options.            (line  602)
   7684 * -V:                                    Options.            (line  602)
   7685 * -x:                                    Options.            (line  608)
   7686 * -X:                                    Options.            (line  612)
   7687 * -Y PATH:                               Options.            (line  627)
   7688 * -y SYMBOL:                             Options.            (line  618)
   7689 * -z defs:                               Options.            (line 1021)
   7690 * -z KEYWORD:                            Options.            (line  631)
   7691 * -z muldefs:                            Options.            (line 1029)
   7692 * .:                                     Location Counter.   (line    6)
   7693 * /DISCARD/:                             Output Section Discarding.
   7694                                                              (line   26)
   7695 * 32-bit PLT entries:                    ARM.                (line  185)
   7696 * :PHDR:                                 Output Section Phdr.
   7697                                                              (line    6)
   7698 * =FILLEXP:                              Output Section Fill.
   7699                                                              (line    6)
   7700 * >REGION:                               Output Section Region.
   7701                                                              (line    6)
   7702 * [COMMON]:                              Input Section Common.
   7703                                                              (line   29)
   7704 * ABSOLUTE (MRI):                        MRI.                (line   33)
   7705 * absolute and relocatable symbols:      Expression Section. (line    6)
   7706 * absolute expressions:                  Expression Section. (line    6)
   7707 * ABSOLUTE(EXP):                         Builtin Functions.  (line   10)
   7708 * ADDR(SECTION):                         Builtin Functions.  (line   17)
   7709 * address, section:                      Output Section Address.
   7710                                                              (line    6)
   7711 * ALIAS (MRI):                           MRI.                (line   44)
   7712 * ALIGN (MRI):                           MRI.                (line   50)
   7713 * align expression:                      Builtin Functions.  (line   38)
   7714 * align location counter:                Builtin Functions.  (line   38)
   7715 * ALIGN(ALIGN):                          Builtin Functions.  (line   38)
   7716 * ALIGN(EXP,ALIGN):                      Builtin Functions.  (line   38)
   7717 * ALIGN(SECTION_ALIGN):                  Forced Output Alignment.
   7718                                                              (line    6)
   7719 * aligned common symbols:                WIN32.              (line  424)
   7720 * ALIGNOF(SECTION):                      Builtin Functions.  (line   64)
   7721 * allocating memory:                     MEMORY.             (line    6)
   7722 * architecture:                          Miscellaneous Commands.
   7723                                                              (line   72)
   7724 * architectures:                         Options.            (line  122)
   7725 * archive files, from cmd line:          Options.            (line  334)
   7726 * archive search path in linker script:  File Commands.      (line   76)
   7727 * arithmetic:                            Expressions.        (line    6)
   7728 * arithmetic operators:                  Operators.          (line    6)
   7729 * ARM interworking support:              ARM.                (line    6)
   7730 * ARM1176 erratum workaround:            ARM.                (line  111)
   7731 * AS_NEEDED(FILES):                      File Commands.      (line   56)
   7732 * ASSERT:                                Miscellaneous Commands.
   7733                                                              (line    9)
   7734 * assertion in linker script:            Miscellaneous Commands.
   7735                                                              (line    9)
   7736 * assignment in scripts:                 Assignments.        (line    6)
   7737 * AT(LMA):                               Output Section LMA. (line    6)
   7738 * AT>LMA_REGION:                         Output Section LMA. (line    6)
   7739 * automatic data imports:                WIN32.              (line  191)
   7740 * back end:                              BFD.                (line    6)
   7741 * BASE (MRI):                            MRI.                (line   54)
   7742 * BE8:                                   ARM.                (line   28)
   7743 * BFD canonical format:                  Canonical format.   (line   11)
   7744 * BFD requirements:                      BFD.                (line   16)
   7745 * big-endian objects:                    Options.            (line  248)
   7746 * binary input format:                   Options.            (line  134)
   7747 * BLOCK(EXP):                            Builtin Functions.  (line   77)
   7748 * bug criteria:                          Bug Criteria.       (line    6)
   7749 * bug reports:                           Bug Reporting.      (line    6)
   7750 * bugs in ld:                            Reporting Bugs.     (line    6)
   7751 * BYTE(EXPRESSION):                      Output Section Data.
   7752                                                              (line    6)
   7753 * C++ constructors, arranging in link:   Output Section Keywords.
   7754                                                              (line   19)
   7755 * CHIP (MRI):                            MRI.                (line   58)
   7756 * COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE:                   Environment.        (line   29)
   7757 * combining symbols, warnings on:        Options.            (line 1394)
   7758 * command files:                         Scripts.            (line    6)
   7759 * command line:                          Options.            (line    6)
   7760 * common allocation:                     Options.            (line  168)
   7761 * common allocation in linker script:    Miscellaneous Commands.
   7762                                                              (line   20)
   7763 * common symbol placement:               Input Section Common.
   7764                                                              (line    6)
   7765 * COMMONPAGESIZE:                        Symbolic Constants. (line   13)
   7766 * compatibility, MRI:                    Options.            (line  158)
   7767 * CONSTANT:                              Symbolic Constants. (line    6)
   7768 * constants in linker scripts:           Constants.          (line    6)
   7769 * constraints on output sections:        Output Section Constraint.
   7770                                                              (line    6)
   7771 * constructors:                          Options.            (line  583)
   7772 * CONSTRUCTORS:                          Output Section Keywords.
   7773                                                              (line   19)
   7774 * constructors, arranging in link:       Output Section Keywords.
   7775                                                              (line   19)
   7776 * Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround:  ARM.                (line  174)
   7777 * Cortex-A8 erratum workaround:          ARM.                (line  165)
   7778 * crash of linker:                       Bug Criteria.       (line    9)
   7779 * CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS:                 Output Section Keywords.
   7780                                                              (line    9)
   7781 * creating a DEF file:                   WIN32.              (line  158)
   7782 * cross reference table:                 Options.            (line  888)
   7783 * cross references:                      Miscellaneous Commands.
   7784                                                              (line   56)
   7785 * current output location:               Location Counter.   (line    6)
   7786 * data:                                  Output Section Data.
   7787                                                              (line    6)
   7788 * DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(MAXPAGESIZE, COMMONPAGESIZE): Builtin Functions.
   7789                                                              (line   82)
   7790 * DATA_SEGMENT_END(EXP):                 Builtin Functions.  (line  103)
   7791 * DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(OFFSET, EXP):   Builtin Functions.  (line  109)
   7792 * dbx:                                   Options.            (line 1309)
   7793 * DEF files, creating:                   Options.            (line 1801)
   7794 * default emulation:                     Environment.        (line   21)
   7795 * default input format:                  Environment.        (line    9)
   7796 * DEFINED(SYMBOL):                       Builtin Functions.  (line  122)
   7797 * deleting local symbols:                Options.            (line  608)
   7798 * demangling, default:                   Environment.        (line   29)
   7799 * demangling, from command line:         Options.            (line  930)
   7800 * direct linking to a dll:               WIN32.              (line  239)
   7801 * discarding sections:                   Output Section Discarding.
   7802                                                              (line    6)
   7803 * discontinuous memory:                  MEMORY.             (line    6)
   7804 * DLLs, creating:                        Options.            (line 1809)
   7805 * DLLs, linking to:                      Options.            (line 1833)
   7806 * dot:                                   Location Counter.   (line    6)
   7807 * dot inside sections:                   Location Counter.   (line   36)
   7808 * dot outside sections:                  Location Counter.   (line   66)
   7809 * dynamic linker, from command line:     Options.            (line  943)
   7810 * dynamic symbol table:                  Options.            (line  221)
   7811 * ELF program headers:                   PHDRS.              (line    6)
   7812 * emulation:                             Options.            (line  392)
   7813 * emulation, default:                    Environment.        (line   21)
   7814 * END (MRI):                             MRI.                (line   62)
   7815 * endianness:                            Options.            (line  248)
   7816 * entry point:                           Entry Point.        (line    6)
   7817 * entry point, from command line:        Options.            (line  187)
   7818 * entry point, thumb:                    ARM.                (line   17)
   7819 * ENTRY(SYMBOL):                         Entry Point.        (line    6)
   7820 * error on valid input:                  Bug Criteria.       (line   12)
   7821 * example of linker script:              Simple Example.     (line    6)
   7822 * exporting DLL symbols:                 WIN32.              (line   19)
   7823 * expression evaluation order:           Evaluation.         (line    6)
   7824 * expression sections:                   Expression Section. (line    6)
   7825 * expression, absolute:                  Builtin Functions.  (line   10)
   7826 * expressions:                           Expressions.        (line    6)
   7827 * EXTERN:                                Miscellaneous Commands.
   7828                                                              (line   13)
   7829 * fatal signal:                          Bug Criteria.       (line    9)
   7830 * file name wildcard patterns:           Input Section Wildcards.
   7831                                                              (line    6)
   7832 * FILEHDR:                               PHDRS.              (line   62)
   7833 * filename symbols:                      Output Section Keywords.
   7834                                                              (line    9)
   7835 * fill pattern, entire section:          Output Section Fill.
   7836                                                              (line    6)
   7837 * FILL(EXPRESSION):                      Output Section Data.
   7838                                                              (line   39)
   7839 * finalization function:                 Options.            (line  300)
   7840 * first input file:                      File Commands.      (line   84)
   7841 * first instruction:                     Entry Point.        (line    6)
   7842 * FIX_V4BX:                              ARM.                (line   49)
   7843 * FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING:                 ARM.                (line   62)
   7844 * FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION:               Miscellaneous Commands.
   7845                                                              (line   20)
   7846 * forcing input section alignment:       Forced Input Alignment.
   7847                                                              (line    6)
   7848 * forcing output section alignment:      Forced Output Alignment.
   7849                                                              (line    6)
   7850 * forcing the creation of dynamic sections: Options.         (line  506)
   7851 * FORMAT (MRI):                          MRI.                (line   66)
   7852 * functions in expressions:              Builtin Functions.  (line    6)
   7853 * garbage collection <1>:                Options.            (line  965)
   7854 * garbage collection <2>:                Input Section Keep. (line    6)
   7855 * garbage collection:                    Options.            (line  987)
   7856 * generating optimized output:           Options.            (line  466)
   7857 * GNU linker:                            Overview.           (line    6)
   7858 * GNUTARGET:                             Environment.        (line    9)
   7859 * GROUP(FILES):                          File Commands.      (line   49)
   7860 * grouping input files:                  File Commands.      (line   49)
   7861 * groups of archives:                    Options.            (line  731)
   7862 * H8/300 support:                        H8/300.             (line    6)
   7863 * header size:                           Builtin Functions.  (line  190)
   7864 * heap size:                             Options.            (line 1736)
   7865 * help:                                  Options.            (line 1002)
   7866 * HIDDEN:                                HIDDEN.             (line    6)
   7867 * holes:                                 Location Counter.   (line   12)
   7868 * holes, filling:                        Output Section Data.
   7869                                                              (line   39)
   7870 * HPPA multiple sub-space stubs:         HPPA ELF32.         (line    6)
   7871 * HPPA stub grouping:                    HPPA ELF32.         (line   12)
   7872 * i960 support:                          i960.               (line    6)
   7873 * image base:                            Options.            (line 1743)
   7874 * implicit linker scripts:               Implicit Linker Scripts.
   7875                                                              (line    6)
   7876 * import libraries:                      WIN32.              (line   10)
   7877 * INCLUDE FILENAME:                      File Commands.      (line    9)
   7878 * including a linker script:             File Commands.      (line    9)
   7879 * including an entire archive:           Options.            (line 1507)
   7880 * incremental link:                      Options.            (line  325)
   7881 * INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION:             Miscellaneous Commands.
   7882                                                              (line   25)
   7883 * initialization function:               Options.            (line  328)
   7884 * initialized data in ROM:               Output Section LMA. (line   39)
   7885 * input file format in linker script:    Format Commands.    (line   35)
   7886 * input filename symbols:                Output Section Keywords.
   7887                                                              (line    9)
   7888 * input files in linker scripts:         File Commands.      (line   19)
   7889 * input files, displaying:               Options.            (line  549)
   7890 * input format:                          Options.            (line  134)
   7891 * input object files in linker scripts:  File Commands.      (line   19)
   7892 * input section alignment:               Forced Input Alignment.
   7893                                                              (line    6)
   7894 * input section basics:                  Input Section Basics.
   7895                                                              (line    6)
   7896 * input section wildcards:               Input Section Wildcards.
   7897                                                              (line    6)
   7898 * input sections:                        Input Section.      (line    6)
   7899 * INPUT(FILES):                          File Commands.      (line   19)
   7900 * INSERT:                                Miscellaneous Commands.
   7901                                                              (line   30)
   7902 * insert user script into default script: Miscellaneous Commands.
   7903                                                              (line   30)
   7904 * integer notation:                      Constants.          (line    6)
   7905 * integer suffixes:                      Constants.          (line   15)
   7906 * internal object-file format:           Canonical format.   (line   11)
   7907 * invalid input:                         Bug Criteria.       (line   14)
   7908 * K and M integer suffixes:              Constants.          (line   15)
   7909 * KEEP:                                  Input Section Keep. (line    6)
   7910 * l =:                                   MEMORY.             (line   74)
   7911 * lazy evaluation:                       Evaluation.         (line    6)
   7912 * ld bugs, reporting:                    Bug Reporting.      (line    6)
   7913 * LD_FEATURE(STRING):                    Miscellaneous Commands.
   7914                                                              (line   78)
   7915 * ldata segment origin, cmd line:        Options.            (line 1342)
   7916 * LDEMULATION:                           Environment.        (line   21)
   7917 * len =:                                 MEMORY.             (line   74)
   7918 * LENGTH =:                              MEMORY.             (line   74)
   7919 * LENGTH(MEMORY):                        Builtin Functions.  (line  139)
   7920 * library search path in linker script:  File Commands.      (line   76)
   7921 * link map:                              Options.            (line  402)
   7922 * link-time runtime library search path: Options.            (line 1196)
   7923 * linker crash:                          Bug Criteria.       (line    9)
   7924 * linker script concepts:                Basic Script Concepts.
   7925                                                              (line    6)
   7926 * linker script example:                 Simple Example.     (line    6)
   7927 * linker script file commands:           File Commands.      (line    6)
   7928 * linker script format:                  Script Format.      (line    6)
   7929 * linker script input object files:      File Commands.      (line   19)
   7930 * linker script simple commands:         Simple Commands.    (line    6)
   7931 * linker scripts:                        Scripts.            (line    6)
   7932 * LIST (MRI):                            MRI.                (line   77)
   7933 * little-endian objects:                 Options.            (line  251)
   7934 * LOAD (MRI):                            MRI.                (line   84)
   7935 * load address:                          Output Section LMA. (line    6)
   7936 * LOADADDR(SECTION):                     Builtin Functions.  (line  142)
   7937 * loading, preventing:                   Output Section Type.
   7938                                                              (line   22)
   7939 * local symbols, deleting:               Options.            (line  612)
   7940 * location counter:                      Location Counter.   (line    6)
   7941 * LOG2CEIL(EXP):                         Builtin Functions.  (line  146)
   7942 * LONG(EXPRESSION):                      Output Section Data.
   7943                                                              (line    6)
   7944 * M and K integer suffixes:              Constants.          (line   15)
   7945 * M68HC11 and 68HC12 support:            M68HC11/68HC12.     (line    6)
   7946 * machine architecture:                  Miscellaneous Commands.
   7947                                                              (line   72)
   7948 * machine dependencies:                  Machine Dependent.  (line    6)
   7949 * mapping input sections to output sections: Input Section.  (line    6)
   7950 * MAX:                                   Builtin Functions.  (line  149)
   7951 * MAXPAGESIZE:                           Symbolic Constants. (line   10)
   7952 * MEMORY:                                MEMORY.             (line    6)
   7953 * memory region attributes:              MEMORY.             (line   34)
   7954 * memory regions:                        MEMORY.             (line    6)
   7955 * memory regions and sections:           Output Section Region.
   7956                                                              (line    6)
   7957 * memory usage:                          Options.            (line 1014)
   7958 * Merging exidx entries:                 ARM.                (line  182)
   7959 * MIN:                                   Builtin Functions.  (line  152)
   7960 * MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection: MIPS.         (line    6)
   7961 * Motorola 68K GOT generation:           M68K.               (line    6)
   7962 * MRI compatibility:                     MRI.                (line    6)
   7963 * MSP430 extra sections:                 MSP430.             (line   11)
   7964 * NAME (MRI):                            MRI.                (line   90)
   7965 * name, section:                         Output Section Name.
   7966                                                              (line    6)
   7967 * names:                                 Symbols.            (line    6)
   7968 * naming the output file:                Options.            (line  460)
   7969 * NEXT(EXP):                             Builtin Functions.  (line  156)
   7970 * Nios II call relaxation:               Nios II.            (line    6)
   7971 * NMAGIC:                                Options.            (line  439)
   7972 * NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING:                  ARM.                (line  120)
   7973 * NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING:                 ARM.                (line  127)
   7974 * NOCROSSREFS(SECTIONS):                 Miscellaneous Commands.
   7975                                                              (line   56)
   7976 * NOLOAD:                                Output Section Type.
   7977                                                              (line   22)
   7978 * not enough room for program headers:   Builtin Functions.  (line  195)
   7979 * o =:                                   MEMORY.             (line   69)
   7980 * objdump -i:                            BFD.                (line    6)
   7981 * object file management:                BFD.                (line    6)
   7982 * object files:                          Options.            (line   29)
   7983 * object formats available:              BFD.                (line    6)
   7984 * object size:                           Options.            (line  309)
   7985 * OMAGIC:                                Options.            (line  445)
   7986 * ONLY_IF_RO:                            Output Section Constraint.
   7987                                                              (line    6)
   7988 * ONLY_IF_RW:                            Output Section Constraint.
   7989                                                              (line    6)
   7990 * opening object files:                  BFD outline.        (line    6)
   7991 * operators for arithmetic:              Operators.          (line    6)
   7992 * options:                               Options.            (line    6)
   7993 * ORDER (MRI):                           MRI.                (line   95)
   7994 * org =:                                 MEMORY.             (line   69)
   7995 * ORIGIN =:                              MEMORY.             (line   69)
   7996 * ORIGIN(MEMORY):                        Builtin Functions.  (line  162)
   7997 * orphan:                                Orphan Sections.    (line    6)
   7998 * output file after errors:              Options.            (line 1093)
   7999 * output file format in linker script:   Format Commands.    (line   10)
   8000 * output file name in linker script:     File Commands.      (line   66)
   8001 * output format:                         Options.            (line  996)
   8002 * output section alignment:              Forced Output Alignment.
   8003                                                              (line    6)
   8004 * output section attributes:             Output Section Attributes.
   8005                                                              (line    6)
   8006 * output section data:                   Output Section Data.
   8007                                                              (line    6)
   8008 * OUTPUT(FILENAME):                      File Commands.      (line   66)
   8009 * OUTPUT_ARCH(BFDARCH):                  Miscellaneous Commands.
   8010                                                              (line   72)
   8011 * OUTPUT_FORMAT(BFDNAME):                Format Commands.    (line   10)
   8012 * OVERLAY:                               Overlay Description.
   8013                                                              (line    6)
   8014 * overlays:                              Overlay Description.
   8015                                                              (line    6)
   8016 * partial link:                          Options.            (line  510)
   8017 * PE import table prefixing:             ARM.                (line   23)
   8018 * PHDRS:                                 PHDRS.              (line   62)
   8019 * PIC_VENEER:                            ARM.                (line  133)
   8020 * pop state governing input file handling: Options.          (line  494)
   8021 * position independent executables:      Options.            (line 1120)
   8022 * PowerPC ELF32 options:                 PowerPC ELF32.      (line   16)
   8023 * PowerPC GOT:                           PowerPC ELF32.      (line   33)
   8024 * PowerPC long branches:                 PowerPC ELF32.      (line    6)
   8025 * PowerPC PLT:                           PowerPC ELF32.      (line   16)
   8026 * PowerPC stub symbols:                  PowerPC ELF32.      (line   47)
   8027 * PowerPC TLS optimization:              PowerPC ELF32.      (line   51)
   8028 * PowerPC64 dot symbols:                 PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   33)
   8029 * PowerPC64 ELF64 options:               PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line    6)
   8030 * PowerPC64 multi-TOC:                   PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   74)
   8031 * PowerPC64 OPD optimization:            PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   48)
   8032 * PowerPC64 OPD spacing:                 PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   54)
   8033 * PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain:  PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line  104)
   8034 * PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety: PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line  110)
   8035 * PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment:          PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   96)
   8036 * PowerPC64 stub grouping:               PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line    6)
   8037 * PowerPC64 stub symbols:                PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   29)
   8038 * PowerPC64 TLS optimization:            PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   43)
   8039 * PowerPC64 TOC optimization:            PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   60)
   8040 * PowerPC64 TOC sorting:                 PowerPC64 ELF64.    (line   86)
   8041 * precedence in expressions:             Operators.          (line    6)
   8042 * prevent unnecessary loading:           Output Section Type.
   8043                                                              (line   22)
   8044 * program headers:                       PHDRS.              (line    6)
   8045 * program headers and sections:          Output Section Phdr.
   8046                                                              (line    6)
   8047 * program headers, not enough room:      Builtin Functions.  (line  195)
   8048 * program segments:                      PHDRS.              (line    6)
   8049 * PROVIDE:                               PROVIDE.            (line    6)
   8050 * PROVIDE_HIDDEN:                        PROVIDE_HIDDEN.     (line    6)
   8051 * PUBLIC (MRI):                          MRI.                (line  103)
   8052 * push state governing input file handling: Options.         (line  476)
   8053 * QUAD(EXPRESSION):                      Output Section Data.
   8054                                                              (line    6)
   8055 * quoted symbol names:                   Symbols.            (line    6)
   8056 * read-only text:                        Options.            (line  439)
   8057 * read/write from cmd line:              Options.            (line  445)
   8058 * region alias:                          REGION_ALIAS.       (line    6)
   8059 * region names:                          REGION_ALIAS.       (line    6)
   8060 * REGION_ALIAS(ALIAS, REGION):           REGION_ALIAS.       (line    6)
   8061 * regions of memory:                     MEMORY.             (line    6)
   8062 * relative expressions:                  Expression Section. (line    6)
   8063 * relaxing addressing modes:             Options.            (line 1134)
   8064 * relaxing on H8/300:                    H8/300.             (line    9)
   8065 * relaxing on i960:                      i960.               (line   31)
   8066 * relaxing on M68HC11:                   M68HC11/68HC12.     (line   12)
   8067 * relaxing on NDS32:                     NDS32.              (line    6)
   8068 * relaxing on Xtensa:                    Xtensa.             (line   27)
   8069 * relocatable and absolute symbols:      Expression Section. (line    6)
   8070 * relocatable output:                    Options.            (line  510)
   8071 * removing sections:                     Output Section Discarding.
   8072                                                              (line    6)
   8073 * reporting bugs in ld:                  Reporting Bugs.     (line    6)
   8074 * requirements for BFD:                  BFD.                (line   16)
   8075 * retain relocations in final executable: Options.           (line  497)
   8076 * retaining specified symbols:           Options.            (line 1160)
   8077 * rodata segment origin, cmd line:       Options.            (line 1336)
   8078 * ROM initialized data:                  Output Section LMA. (line   39)
   8079 * round up expression:                   Builtin Functions.  (line   38)
   8080 * round up location counter:             Builtin Functions.  (line   38)
   8081 * runtime library name:                  Options.            (line  316)
   8082 * runtime library search path:           Options.            (line 1174)
   8083 * runtime pseudo-relocation:             WIN32.              (line  217)
   8084 * scaled integers:                       Constants.          (line   15)
   8085 * scommon section:                       Input Section Common.
   8086                                                              (line   20)
   8087 * script files:                          Options.            (line  553)
   8088 * scripts:                               Scripts.            (line    6)
   8089 * search directory, from cmd line:       Options.            (line  367)
   8090 * search path in linker script:          File Commands.      (line   76)
   8091 * SEARCH_DIR(PATH):                      File Commands.      (line   76)
   8092 * SECT (MRI):                            MRI.                (line  109)
   8093 * section address:                       Output Section Address.
   8094                                                              (line    6)
   8095 * section address in expression:         Builtin Functions.  (line   17)
   8096 * section alignment:                     Builtin Functions.  (line   64)
   8097 * section alignment, warnings on:        Options.            (line 1485)
   8098 * section data:                          Output Section Data.
   8099                                                              (line    6)
   8100 * section fill pattern:                  Output Section Fill.
   8101                                                              (line    6)
   8102 * section load address:                  Output Section LMA. (line    6)
   8103 * section load address in expression:    Builtin Functions.  (line  142)
   8104 * section name:                          Output Section Name.
   8105                                                              (line    6)
   8106 * section name wildcard patterns:        Input Section Wildcards.
   8107                                                              (line    6)
   8108 * section size:                          Builtin Functions.  (line  174)
   8109 * section, assigning to memory region:   Output Section Region.
   8110                                                              (line    6)
   8111 * section, assigning to program header:  Output Section Phdr.
   8112                                                              (line    6)
   8113 * SECTIONS:                              SECTIONS.           (line    6)
   8114 * sections, discarding:                  Output Section Discarding.
   8115                                                              (line    6)
   8116 * segment origins, cmd line:             Options.            (line 1325)
   8117 * SEGMENT_START(SEGMENT, DEFAULT):       Builtin Functions.  (line  165)
   8118 * segments, ELF:                         PHDRS.              (line    6)
   8119 * shared libraries:                      Options.            (line 1253)
   8120 * SHORT(EXPRESSION):                     Output Section Data.
   8121                                                              (line    6)
   8122 * SIZEOF(SECTION):                       Builtin Functions.  (line  174)
   8123 * SIZEOF_HEADERS:                        Builtin Functions.  (line  190)
   8124 * small common symbols:                  Input Section Common.
   8125                                                              (line   20)
   8126 * SORT:                                  Input Section Wildcards.
   8127                                                              (line   65)
   8128 * SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT:                     Input Section Wildcards.
   8129                                                              (line   54)
   8130 * SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY:                 Input Section Wildcards.
   8131                                                              (line   60)
   8132 * SORT_BY_NAME:                          Input Section Wildcards.
   8133                                                              (line   46)
   8134 * SORT_NONE:                             Input Section Wildcards.
   8135                                                              (line  106)
   8136 * SPU:                                   SPU ELF.            (line   29)
   8137 * SPU ELF options:                       SPU ELF.            (line    6)
   8138 * SPU extra overlay stubs:               SPU ELF.            (line   19)
   8139 * SPU local store size:                  SPU ELF.            (line   24)
   8140 * SPU overlay stub symbols:              SPU ELF.            (line   15)
   8141 * SPU overlays:                          SPU ELF.            (line    9)
   8142 * SPU plugins:                           SPU ELF.            (line    6)
   8143 * SQUAD(EXPRESSION):                     Output Section Data.
   8144                                                              (line    6)
   8145 * stack size:                            Options.            (line 1991)
   8146 * standard Unix system:                  Options.            (line    7)
   8147 * start of execution:                    Entry Point.        (line    6)
   8148 * STARTUP(FILENAME):                     File Commands.      (line   84)
   8149 * strip all symbols:                     Options.            (line  540)
   8150 * strip debugger symbols:                Options.            (line  544)
   8151 * stripping all but some symbols:        Options.            (line 1160)
   8152 * STUB_GROUP_SIZE:                       ARM.                (line  138)
   8153 * SUBALIGN(SUBSECTION_ALIGN):            Forced Input Alignment.
   8154                                                              (line    6)
   8155 * suffixes for integers:                 Constants.          (line   15)
   8156 * symbol defaults:                       Builtin Functions.  (line  122)
   8157 * symbol definition, scripts:            Assignments.        (line    6)
   8158 * symbol names:                          Symbols.            (line    6)
   8159 * symbol tracing:                        Options.            (line  618)
   8160 * symbol versions:                       VERSION.            (line    6)
   8161 * symbol-only input:                     Options.            (line  529)
   8162 * symbolic constants:                    Symbolic Constants. (line    6)
   8163 * symbols, from command line:            Options.            (line  917)
   8164 * symbols, relocatable and absolute:     Expression Section. (line    6)
   8165 * symbols, retaining selectively:        Options.            (line 1160)
   8166 * synthesizing linker:                   Options.            (line 1134)
   8167 * synthesizing on H8/300:                H8/300.             (line   14)
   8168 * TARGET(BFDNAME):                       Format Commands.    (line   35)
   8169 * TARGET1:                               ARM.                (line   32)
   8170 * TARGET2:                               ARM.                (line   37)
   8171 * text segment origin, cmd line:         Options.            (line 1332)
   8172 * thumb entry point:                     ARM.                (line   17)
   8173 * TI COFF versions:                      TI COFF.            (line    6)
   8174 * traditional format:                    Options.            (line 1304)
   8175 * trampoline generation on M68HC11:      M68HC11/68HC12.     (line   31)
   8176 * trampoline generation on M68HC12:      M68HC11/68HC12.     (line   31)
   8177 * unallocated address, next:             Builtin Functions.  (line  156)
   8178 * undefined symbol:                      Options.            (line  575)
   8179 * undefined symbol in linker script:     Miscellaneous Commands.
   8180                                                              (line   13)
   8181 * undefined symbols, warnings on:        Options.            (line 1481)
   8182 * uninitialized data placement:          Input Section Common.
   8183                                                              (line    6)
   8184 * unspecified memory:                    Output Section Data.
   8185                                                              (line   39)
   8186 * usage:                                 Options.            (line 1002)
   8187 * USE_BLX:                               ARM.                (line   74)
   8188 * using a DEF file:                      WIN32.              (line   57)
   8189 * using auto-export functionality:       WIN32.              (line   22)
   8190 * Using decorations:                     WIN32.              (line  162)
   8191 * variables, defining:                   Assignments.        (line    6)
   8192 * verbose[=NUMBER]:                      Options.            (line 1375)
   8193 * version:                               Options.            (line  602)
   8194 * version script:                        VERSION.            (line    6)
   8195 * version script, symbol versions:       Options.            (line 1383)
   8196 * VERSION {script text}:                 VERSION.            (line    6)
   8197 * versions of symbols:                   VERSION.            (line    6)
   8198 * VFP11_DENORM_FIX:                      ARM.                (line   83)
   8199 * warnings, on combining symbols:        Options.            (line 1394)
   8200 * warnings, on section alignment:        Options.            (line 1485)
   8201 * warnings, on undefined symbols:        Options.            (line 1481)
   8202 * weak externals:                        WIN32.              (line  407)
   8203 * what is this?:                         Overview.           (line    6)
   8204 * wildcard file name patterns:           Input Section Wildcards.
   8205                                                              (line    6)
   8206 * Xtensa options:                        Xtensa.             (line   56)
   8207 * Xtensa processors:                     Xtensa.             (line    6)
   8208 
   8209 
   8210 
   8211 Tag Table:
   8212 Node: Top710
   8213 Node: Overview1493
   8214 Node: Invocation2607
   8215 Node: Options3015
   8216 Node: Environment98821
   8217 Node: Scripts100581
   8218 Node: Basic Script Concepts102315
   8219 Node: Script Format105023
   8220 Node: Simple Example105886
   8221 Node: Simple Commands108982
   8222 Node: Entry Point109488
   8223 Node: File Commands110421
   8224 Node: Format Commands114541
   8225 Node: REGION_ALIAS116497
   8226 Node: Miscellaneous Commands121329
   8227 Node: Assignments124937
   8228 Node: Simple Assignments125448
   8229 Node: HIDDEN127183
   8230 Node: PROVIDE127813
   8231 Node: PROVIDE_HIDDEN129006
   8232 Node: Source Code Reference129250
   8233 Node: SECTIONS132832
   8234 Node: Output Section Description134723
   8235 Node: Output Section Name135967
   8236 Node: Output Section Address136843
   8237 Node: Input Section139078
   8238 Node: Input Section Basics139879
   8239 Node: Input Section Wildcards143785
   8240 Node: Input Section Common148992
   8241 Node: Input Section Keep150474
   8242 Node: Input Section Example150964
   8243 Node: Output Section Data151932
   8244 Node: Output Section Keywords154709
   8245 Node: Output Section Discarding158278
   8246 Node: Output Section Attributes159771
   8247 Node: Output Section Type160872
   8248 Node: Output Section LMA161943
   8249 Node: Forced Output Alignment165014
   8250 Node: Forced Input Alignment165444
   8251 Node: Output Section Constraint165833
   8252 Node: Output Section Region166261
   8253 Node: Output Section Phdr166694
   8254 Node: Output Section Fill167358
   8255 Node: Overlay Description168500
   8256 Node: MEMORY172946
   8257 Node: PHDRS177281
   8258 Node: VERSION182535
   8259 Node: Expressions190628
   8260 Node: Constants191557
   8261 Node: Symbolic Constants192432
   8262 Node: Symbols192983
   8263 Node: Orphan Sections193730
   8264 Node: Location Counter194895
   8265 Node: Operators199331
   8266 Node: Evaluation200253
   8267 Node: Expression Section201617
   8268 Node: Builtin Functions205481
   8269 Node: Implicit Linker Scripts213677
   8270 Node: Machine Dependent214452
   8271 Node: H8/300215576
   8272 Node: i960217638
   8273 Node: M68HC11/68HC12219334
   8274 Node: ARM220776
   8275 Node: HPPA ELF32229814
   8276 Node: M68K231437
   8277 Node: MIPS232346
   8278 Node: MMIX232870
   8279 Node: MSP430234035
   8280 Node: NDS32235075
   8281 Node: Nios II236041
   8282 Node: PowerPC ELF32237357
   8283 Node: PowerPC64 ELF64240188
   8284 Node: SPU ELF246422
   8285 Node: TI COFF249054
   8286 Node: WIN32249580
   8287 Node: Xtensa269706
   8288 Node: BFD272671
   8289 Node: BFD outline274126
   8290 Node: BFD information loss275412
   8291 Node: Canonical format277929
   8292 Node: Reporting Bugs282286
   8293 Node: Bug Criteria282980
   8294 Node: Bug Reporting283679
   8295 Node: MRI290718
   8296 Node: GNU Free Documentation License295361
   8297 Node: LD Index320517
   8298 
   8299 End Tag Table
   8300